1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 28 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 33 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 34 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 35 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 36 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 46 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 48 #include <algorithm> 49 #include <cstring> 50 #include <functional> 51 #include <unordered_map> 52 53 using namespace clang; 54 using namespace sema; 55 56 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 57 if (OwnedType) { 58 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 59 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 60 } 61 62 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 63 } 64 65 namespace { 66 67 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 68 public: 69 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 70 bool AllowTemplates = false, 71 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 72 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 73 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 74 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 75 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 76 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 77 } 78 79 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 80 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 81 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 82 return false; 83 84 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 85 return AllowTemplates; 86 87 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 88 if (!IsType) 89 return false; 90 91 if (AllowNonTemplates) 92 return true; 93 94 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 95 // as a template or as a non-template. 96 if (AllowTemplates) { 97 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 98 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 99 return false; 100 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 101 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 102 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 103 } 104 105 return false; 106 } 107 108 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 109 } 110 111 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 112 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 113 } 114 115 private: 116 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 117 bool WantClassName; 118 bool AllowTemplates; 119 bool AllowNonTemplates; 120 }; 121 122 } // end anonymous namespace 123 124 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 125 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 126 switch (Kind) { 127 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 128 // token kind is a valid type specifier 129 case tok::kw_short: 130 case tok::kw_long: 131 case tok::kw___int64: 132 case tok::kw___int128: 133 case tok::kw_signed: 134 case tok::kw_unsigned: 135 case tok::kw_void: 136 case tok::kw_char: 137 case tok::kw_int: 138 case tok::kw_half: 139 case tok::kw_float: 140 case tok::kw_double: 141 case tok::kw___bf16: 142 case tok::kw__Float16: 143 case tok::kw___float128: 144 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 145 case tok::kw_bool: 146 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 147 case tok::kw___auto_type: 148 return true; 149 150 case tok::annot_typename: 151 case tok::kw_char16_t: 152 case tok::kw_char32_t: 153 case tok::kw_typeof: 154 case tok::annot_decltype: 155 case tok::kw_decltype: 156 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 157 158 case tok::kw_char8_t: 159 return getLangOpts().Char8; 160 161 default: 162 break; 163 } 164 165 return false; 166 } 167 168 namespace { 169 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 170 NotFound, 171 FoundNonType, 172 FoundType 173 }; 174 } // end anonymous namespace 175 176 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 177 /// dependent class. 178 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 179 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 180 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 181 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 182 SourceLocation NameLoc, 183 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 184 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 185 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 186 // Look for type decls in base classes. 187 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 188 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 189 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 190 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 191 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 192 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 193 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 194 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 195 // templates. 196 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 197 continue; 198 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 199 if (!TD) 200 continue; 201 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 202 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 203 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 204 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 205 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 206 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 207 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 208 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 209 BaseRD = PS; 210 } 211 } 212 } 213 if (BaseRD) { 214 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 215 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 216 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 217 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 218 } 219 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 220 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 221 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 222 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 224 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 225 break; 226 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 227 break; 228 } 229 } 230 } 231 } 232 233 return FoundTypeDecl; 234 } 235 236 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 237 const IdentifierInfo &II, 238 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 239 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 240 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 241 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 242 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 243 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 244 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 DC = DC->getParent()) { 246 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 247 // templates. 248 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 249 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 250 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 251 } 252 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 253 return nullptr; 254 255 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 256 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 257 // lookup during template instantiation. 258 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II; 259 260 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 261 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 262 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 263 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 264 265 CXXScopeSpec SS; 266 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 267 268 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 269 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 270 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 271 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 272 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 273 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 274 } 275 276 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 277 /// return the declaration of that type. 278 /// 279 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 280 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 281 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 282 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 283 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 284 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 285 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 286 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 287 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 288 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 289 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 290 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 291 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 292 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 293 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 294 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 295 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 296 297 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 298 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 299 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 300 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 301 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 302 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 303 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 305 306 if (!LookupCtx) { 307 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 308 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 309 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 310 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 311 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 312 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 313 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 314 // 315 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 316 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 317 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 318 return nullptr; 319 320 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 321 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 322 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 323 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 324 325 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 326 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 327 II, NameLoc); 328 return ParsedType::make(T); 329 } 330 331 return nullptr; 332 } 333 334 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 335 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 336 return nullptr; 337 } 338 339 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 340 // lookup for class-names. 341 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 342 LookupOrdinaryName; 343 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 344 if (LookupCtx) { 345 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 346 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 347 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 348 // nested-name-specifier. 349 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 350 351 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 352 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 353 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 354 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 355 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 356 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 357 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 358 LookupName(Result, S); 359 } 360 } else { 361 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 362 LookupName(Result, S); 363 364 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 365 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 366 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 367 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 368 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 369 return TypeInBase; 370 } 371 } 372 373 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 374 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 375 case LookupResult::NotFound: 376 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 377 if (CorrectedII) { 378 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 379 AllowDeducedTemplate); 380 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 381 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 382 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 383 TemplateTy Template; 384 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 385 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 386 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 387 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 388 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 389 if (SS && NNS) { 390 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 391 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 392 } 393 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 394 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 395 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 396 // is handled elsewhere). 397 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 398 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 399 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 400 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 401 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 402 IsCtorOrDtorName, 403 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 404 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 405 if (Ty) { 406 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 407 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 408 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 409 if (SS && NNS) 410 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 411 *CorrectedII = NewII; 412 return Ty; 413 } 414 } 415 } 416 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 417 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 418 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 419 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 420 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 421 return nullptr; 422 423 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 424 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 425 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 426 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 427 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 428 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 429 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 430 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 431 return nullptr; 432 } 433 434 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 435 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 436 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 437 NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 438 if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>( 439 RealRes) || 440 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) { 441 if (!IIDecl || 442 // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic. 443 RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) 444 IIDecl = RealRes; 445 } 446 } 447 448 if (!IIDecl) { 449 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 450 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 451 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 452 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 453 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 454 // a type name. 455 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 456 return nullptr; 457 } 458 459 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 460 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 461 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 462 // perform the name lookup again. 463 break; 464 465 case LookupResult::Found: 466 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 467 break; 468 } 469 470 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 471 472 QualType T; 473 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 474 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 475 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 476 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 477 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 478 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 479 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 480 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 481 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 482 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 483 << &II << /*Type*/1; 484 485 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 486 487 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 488 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 489 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 490 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 491 if (!HasTrailingDot) 492 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 493 } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 494 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc); 495 // Recover with 'int' 496 T = Context.IntTy; 497 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 498 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) 499 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName(TD), 500 QualType(), false); 501 } 502 503 if (T.isNull()) { 504 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 505 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 506 return nullptr; 507 } 508 509 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 510 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 511 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 512 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 513 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) { 514 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 515 // Construct a type with type-source information. 516 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 517 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 518 519 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 520 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 521 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 522 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 523 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 524 } else { 525 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 526 } 527 } 528 529 return ParsedType::make(T); 530 } 531 532 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 533 static NestedNameSpecifier * 534 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 535 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 536 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 537 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 538 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 539 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 540 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 541 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 542 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 543 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 544 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 545 } 546 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 547 } 548 549 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 550 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 551 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 552 /// correctly rejects. 553 static const CXXRecordDecl * 554 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 555 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 556 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 557 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 558 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 559 return MD->getParent(); 560 } 561 return nullptr; 562 } 563 564 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 565 SourceLocation NameLoc, 566 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 567 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 568 569 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 570 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 571 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 572 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 573 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 574 // lookup is retried. 575 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 576 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 577 // name specifiers. 578 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 579 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 580 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 581 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 582 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 583 // instantiation time. 584 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 585 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 586 587 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 588 // template instantiation. 589 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 590 << RD; 591 } else { 592 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 593 return ParsedType(); 594 } 595 596 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 597 598 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 599 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 600 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 601 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 602 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 603 604 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 605 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 606 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 607 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 608 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 609 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 610 } 611 612 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 613 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 614 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 615 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 616 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 617 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 618 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 619 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 620 LookupName(R, S, false); 621 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 622 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 623 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 624 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 625 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 626 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 627 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 628 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 629 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 630 } 631 } 632 633 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 634 } 635 636 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 637 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 638 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 639 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 640 /// @code 641 /// template<class T> class A { 642 /// public: 643 /// typedef int TYPE; 644 /// }; 645 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 646 /// public: 647 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 648 /// }; 649 /// @endcode 650 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 651 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 652 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 653 return true; 654 655 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 656 657 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 658 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 659 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 660 return true; 661 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 662 } 663 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 664 } 665 666 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 667 SourceLocation IILoc, 668 Scope *S, 669 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 670 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 671 bool IsTemplateName) { 672 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 673 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 674 return; 675 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 676 SuggestedType = nullptr; 677 678 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 679 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 680 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 681 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 682 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 683 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 684 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 685 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 686 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 687 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 688 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 689 // We corrected to a keyword. 690 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 691 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 692 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 693 << II); 694 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 695 } else { 696 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 697 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 698 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 699 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 700 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 701 << II, CanRecover); 702 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 703 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 704 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 705 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 706 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 707 PDiag(IsTemplateName 708 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 709 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 710 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 711 CanRecover); 712 } else { 713 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 714 } 715 716 if (!CanRecover) 717 return; 718 719 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 720 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 721 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 722 SourceRange(IILoc)); 723 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 724 SuggestedType = 725 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 726 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 727 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 728 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 729 } 730 return; 731 } 732 733 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 734 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 735 UnqualifiedId Name; 736 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 737 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 738 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 739 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 740 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 741 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 742 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 743 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 744 return; 745 } 746 } 747 748 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 749 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 750 751 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 752 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 753 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 754 << II; 755 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 756 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 757 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 758 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 759 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 760 SuggestedType = 761 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 762 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 763 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 764 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 765 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 766 767 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 768 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 769 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 770 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 771 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 772 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 773 } else { 774 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 775 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 776 } 777 } 778 779 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 780 /// or 781 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 782 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 783 NextToken.is(tok::less); 784 785 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 786 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 787 return true; 788 789 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 790 return true; 791 } 792 793 return false; 794 } 795 796 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 797 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 798 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 799 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 800 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 801 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 802 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 803 StringRef FixItTagName; 804 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 805 case TTK_Class: 806 FixItTagName = "class "; 807 break; 808 809 case TTK_Enum: 810 FixItTagName = "enum "; 811 break; 812 813 case TTK_Struct: 814 FixItTagName = "struct "; 815 break; 816 817 case TTK_Interface: 818 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 819 break; 820 821 case TTK_Union: 822 FixItTagName = "union "; 823 break; 824 } 825 826 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 827 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 828 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 829 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 830 831 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 832 I != IEnd; ++I) 833 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 834 << Name << TagName; 835 836 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 837 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 838 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 839 return true; 840 } 841 842 return false; 843 } 844 845 /// Build a ParsedType for a simple-type-specifier with a nested-name-specifier. 846 static ParsedType buildNestedType(Sema &S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 847 QualType T, SourceLocation NameLoc) { 848 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 849 850 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 851 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 852 853 T = S.getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 854 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 855 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 856 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 857 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 858 } 859 860 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 861 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 862 SourceLocation NameLoc, 863 const Token &NextToken, 864 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 865 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 866 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 867 868 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 869 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 870 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 871 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 872 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 873 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 874 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 875 // will reject it later. 876 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 877 } 878 879 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 880 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 881 882 if (SS.isInvalid()) 883 return NameClassification::Error(); 884 885 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 886 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 887 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 888 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 889 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 890 return TypeInBase; 891 } 892 893 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 894 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 895 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 896 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 897 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 898 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 899 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 900 return NameClassification::Error(); 901 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 902 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 903 904 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 905 if (Result.empty()) 906 LookupBuiltin(Result); 907 } 908 909 bool SecondTry = false; 910 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 911 912 Corrected: 913 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 914 case LookupResult::NotFound: 915 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 916 // call. 917 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 918 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 919 // FIXME: Reference? 920 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 921 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 922 923 // C90 6.3.2.2: 924 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 925 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 926 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 927 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 928 // the function call, the declaration 929 // 930 // extern int identifier (); 931 // 932 // appeared. 933 // 934 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. 935 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 936 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 937 } 938 939 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 940 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 941 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 942 // 943 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 944 TemplateName Template = 945 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 946 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 947 } 948 949 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 950 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 951 // "struct", or "union". 952 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 953 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 954 break; 955 } 956 957 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 958 // close to this name. 959 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 960 SecondTry = true; 961 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 962 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 963 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 964 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 965 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 966 967 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 968 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 969 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 970 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 971 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 972 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 973 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 974 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 975 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 976 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 977 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 978 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 979 } 980 981 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 982 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 983 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 984 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 985 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 986 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 987 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 988 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 989 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 990 } 991 992 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 993 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 994 995 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 996 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 997 return Name; 998 999 // Also update the LookupResult... 1000 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 1001 Result.clear(); 1002 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1003 if (FirstDecl) 1004 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 1005 1006 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1007 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1008 // reference the ivar. 1009 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1010 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1011 DeclResult R = 1012 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1013 if (R.isInvalid()) 1014 return NameClassification::Error(); 1015 if (R.isUsable()) 1016 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1017 } 1018 1019 goto Corrected; 1020 } 1021 } 1022 1023 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1024 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1025 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1026 1027 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1028 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1029 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1030 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1031 1032 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1033 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1034 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1035 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1036 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1037 // 1038 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1039 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1040 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1041 // keyword here. 1042 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1043 } 1044 1045 case LookupResult::Found: 1046 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1047 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1048 break; 1049 1050 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1051 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1052 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1053 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1054 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1055 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1056 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1057 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1058 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1059 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1060 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1061 // ambiguous. 1062 // 1063 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1064 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1065 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1066 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1067 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1068 break; 1069 } 1070 } 1071 1072 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1073 return NameClassification::Error(); 1074 } 1075 1076 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1077 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1078 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1079 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1080 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1081 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1082 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1083 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1084 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1085 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1086 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1087 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1088 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1089 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1090 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1091 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1092 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1093 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1094 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1095 1096 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1097 bool IsVarTemplate; 1098 TemplateName Template; 1099 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1100 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1101 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1102 Result.end()); 1103 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1104 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1105 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1106 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1107 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1108 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1109 1110 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1111 Template = 1112 Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1113 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, TD); 1114 else 1115 Template = TemplateName(TD); 1116 } else { 1117 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1118 // name. 1119 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1120 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1121 } 1122 1123 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1124 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1125 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1126 // to based on which function we selected. 1127 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1128 1129 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1130 } 1131 1132 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1133 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1134 } 1135 1136 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1137 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1138 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1139 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1140 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1141 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1142 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 1143 return ParsedType::make(T); 1144 } 1145 1146 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1147 if (!Class) { 1148 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1149 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1150 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1151 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1152 } 1153 1154 if (Class) { 1155 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1156 1157 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1158 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1159 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1160 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1161 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1162 } 1163 1164 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1165 return ParsedType::make(T); 1166 } 1167 1168 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1169 return NameClassification::Concept( 1170 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1171 1172 if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1173 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc); 1174 return NameClassification::Error(); 1175 } 1176 1177 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1178 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1179 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1180 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1181 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1182 1183 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1184 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1185 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1186 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1187 (NextIsOp && 1188 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1189 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1190 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1191 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1192 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1193 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1194 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 1195 return ParsedType::make(T); 1196 } 1197 1198 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1199 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1200 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1201 // the context. 1202 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1203 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1204 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1205 1206 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1207 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1208 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1209 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1210 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1211 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1212 } 1213 1214 ExprResult 1215 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1216 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1217 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1218 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1219 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1220 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1221 } 1222 1223 ExprResult 1224 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1225 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1226 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1227 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1228 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1229 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1230 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1231 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1232 } 1233 1234 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1235 NamedDecl *Found, 1236 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1237 const Token &NextToken) { 1238 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1239 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1240 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1241 1242 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1243 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1244 Result.addDecl(Found); 1245 Result.resolveKind(); 1246 1247 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1248 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1249 } 1250 1251 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1252 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1253 // access expression if necessary. 1254 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1255 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1256 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1257 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1258 1259 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1260 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1261 LookupOrdinaryName); 1262 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1263 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1264 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1265 Result.resolveKind(); 1266 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1267 nullptr, S); 1268 } 1269 1270 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1271 // are necessary. 1272 return ULE; 1273 } 1274 1275 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1276 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1277 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1278 if (!TD) 1279 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1280 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1281 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1282 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1283 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1284 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1285 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1286 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1287 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1288 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1289 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1290 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1291 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1292 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1293 } 1294 1295 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1296 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1297 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1298 CurContext = DC; 1299 S->setEntity(DC); 1300 } 1301 1302 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1303 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1304 1305 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1306 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1307 } 1308 1309 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1310 Decl *D) { 1311 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1312 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1313 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1314 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1315 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1316 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1317 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1318 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1319 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1320 return Result; 1321 } 1322 1323 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1324 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1325 } 1326 1327 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1328 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1329 /// 1330 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1331 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1332 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1333 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1334 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1335 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1336 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1337 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1338 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1339 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1340 // namespace. 1341 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1342 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1343 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1344 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1345 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1346 1347 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1348 1349 #ifndef NDEBUG 1350 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1351 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1352 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1353 #endif 1354 1355 CurContext = DC; 1356 S->setEntity(DC); 1357 1358 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1359 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1360 // template parameter scopes. 1361 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1362 } 1363 } 1364 1365 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1366 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1367 1368 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1369 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1370 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1371 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1372 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1373 1374 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1375 // disappear. 1376 } 1377 1378 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1379 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1380 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1381 1382 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1383 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1384 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1385 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1386 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1387 // class or function template). 1388 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1389 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1390 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1391 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1392 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1393 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1394 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1395 // 1396 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1397 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1398 // scope. For example, for 1399 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1400 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1401 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1402 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1403 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1404 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1405 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1406 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1407 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1408 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1409 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1410 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1411 continue; 1412 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1413 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1414 break; 1415 } 1416 } 1417 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1418 } 1419 } 1420 1421 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1422 // We assume that the caller has already called 1423 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1424 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1425 if (!FD) 1426 return; 1427 1428 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1429 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1430 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1431 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1432 CurContext = FD; 1433 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1434 1435 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1436 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1437 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1438 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1439 S->AddDecl(Param); 1440 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1441 } 1442 } 1443 } 1444 1445 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1446 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1447 // rather than the top-level class. 1448 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1449 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1450 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1451 } 1452 1453 /// Determine whether we allow overloading of the function 1454 /// PrevDecl with another declaration. 1455 /// 1456 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1457 /// whether some new function is actually an overload. It will return 1458 /// true in C++ (where we can always provide overloads) or, as an 1459 /// extension, in C when the previous function is already an 1460 /// overloaded function declaration or has the "overloadable" 1461 /// attribute. 1462 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(LookupResult &Previous, 1463 ASTContext &Context, 1464 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1465 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 1466 return true; 1467 1468 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) 1469 return true; 1470 1471 return Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found && 1472 (Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 1473 New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()); 1474 } 1475 1476 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1477 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1478 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1479 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1480 // scope. 1481 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1482 S = S->getParent(); 1483 1484 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1485 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1486 // into any context. 1487 if (AddToContext) 1488 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1489 1490 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1491 // are function-local declarations. 1492 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1493 return; 1494 1495 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1496 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1497 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1498 return; 1499 1500 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1501 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1502 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1503 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1504 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1505 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1506 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1507 1508 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1509 break; 1510 } 1511 } 1512 1513 S->AddDecl(D); 1514 1515 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1516 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1517 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1518 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1519 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1520 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1521 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1522 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1523 continue; 1524 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1525 break; 1526 } 1527 1528 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1529 } else { 1530 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1531 } 1532 warnOnReservedIdentifier(D); 1533 } 1534 1535 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1536 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1537 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1538 } 1539 1540 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1541 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1542 do { 1543 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1544 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1545 return S; 1546 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1547 1548 return nullptr; 1549 } 1550 1551 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1552 DeclContext*, 1553 ASTContext&); 1554 1555 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1556 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1557 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1558 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1559 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1560 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1561 while (F.hasNext()) { 1562 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1563 1564 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1565 continue; 1566 1567 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1568 continue; 1569 1570 F.erase(); 1571 } 1572 1573 F.done(); 1574 } 1575 1576 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1577 /// have compatible owning modules. 1578 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1579 // FIXME: The Modules TS is not clear about how friend declarations are 1580 // to be treated. It's not meaningful to have different owning modules for 1581 // linkage in redeclarations of the same entity, so for now allow the 1582 // redeclaration and change the owning modules to match. 1583 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1584 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1585 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1586 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1587 return false; 1588 } 1589 1590 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1591 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1592 1593 if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1594 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1595 if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1596 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1597 1598 if (NewM == OldM) 1599 return false; 1600 1601 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1602 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1603 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1604 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1605 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1606 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1607 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1608 << New 1609 << NewIsModuleInterface 1610 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1611 << OldIsModuleInterface 1612 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1613 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1614 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1615 return true; 1616 } 1617 1618 return false; 1619 } 1620 1621 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1622 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1623 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1624 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1625 } 1626 1627 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1628 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1629 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1630 while (F.hasNext()) 1631 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1632 F.erase(); 1633 1634 F.done(); 1635 } 1636 1637 /// Check for this common pattern: 1638 /// @code 1639 /// class S { 1640 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1641 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1642 /// }; 1643 /// @endcode 1644 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1645 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1646 // the decl here. 1647 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1648 return false; 1649 1650 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1651 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1652 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1653 } 1654 1655 // We need this to handle 1656 // 1657 // typedef struct { 1658 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1659 // } A; 1660 // 1661 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1662 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1663 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1664 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1665 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1666 // not. 1667 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1668 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1669 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1670 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1671 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1672 return true; 1673 } 1674 DC = DC->getParent(); 1675 } 1676 1677 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1678 } 1679 1680 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1681 // these semantics. 1682 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1683 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1684 return false; 1685 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1686 } 1687 1688 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1689 assert(D); 1690 1691 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1692 return false; 1693 1694 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1695 // of members of class templates. 1696 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1697 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1698 return false; 1699 1700 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1701 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1702 return false; 1703 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1704 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1705 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1706 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1707 return false; 1708 1709 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1710 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1711 return false; 1712 } else { 1713 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1714 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1715 return false; 1716 } 1717 1718 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1719 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1720 return false; 1721 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1722 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1723 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1724 // like "inline".) 1725 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1726 return false; 1727 1728 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1729 return false; 1730 1731 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1732 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1733 return false; 1734 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1735 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1736 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1737 return false; 1738 1739 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1740 return false; 1741 } else { 1742 return false; 1743 } 1744 1745 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1746 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1747 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1748 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1749 } 1750 1751 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1752 if (!D) 1753 return; 1754 1755 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1756 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1757 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1758 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1759 } 1760 1761 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1762 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1763 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1764 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1765 } 1766 1767 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1768 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1769 } 1770 1771 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1772 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1773 return false; 1774 1775 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1776 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1777 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1778 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1779 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1780 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1781 return false; 1782 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1783 return false; 1784 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1785 return false; 1786 } 1787 1788 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1789 return false; 1790 1791 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1792 return true; 1793 1794 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1795 // functions. 1796 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1797 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1798 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1799 WithinFunction = 1800 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1801 if (!WithinFunction) 1802 return false; 1803 1804 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1805 return true; 1806 1807 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1808 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1809 return false; 1810 1811 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1812 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1813 1814 // White-list anything with an __attribute__((unused)) type. 1815 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1816 1817 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1818 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1819 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1820 return false; 1821 } 1822 1823 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1824 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1825 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1826 return false; 1827 1828 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 1829 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 1830 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1831 1832 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1833 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1834 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1835 return false; 1836 1837 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1838 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1839 return false; 1840 1841 if (const Expr *Init = VD->getInit()) { 1842 if (const ExprWithCleanups *Cleanups = 1843 dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1844 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1845 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1846 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1847 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1848 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1849 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 1850 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 1851 return false; 1852 } 1853 1854 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 1855 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 1856 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) 1857 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 1858 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 1859 return false; 1860 } 1861 } 1862 } 1863 1864 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1865 } 1866 1867 return true; 1868 } 1869 1870 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1871 FixItHint &Hint) { 1872 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1873 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 1874 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 1875 true); 1876 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1877 return; 1878 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 1879 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 1880 } 1881 } 1882 1883 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1884 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1885 return; 1886 1887 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1888 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 1889 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 1890 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 1891 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 1892 } 1893 } 1894 1895 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 1896 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 1897 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1898 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 1899 return; 1900 1901 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 1902 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 1903 // at end-of-translation-unit. 1904 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 1905 return; 1906 } 1907 1908 FixItHint Hint; 1909 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 1910 1911 unsigned DiagID; 1912 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 1913 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 1914 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1915 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 1916 else 1917 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 1918 1919 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 1920 } 1921 1922 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) { 1923 // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. 1924 if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1925 return; 1926 1927 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1928 1929 if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1930 return; 1931 1932 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1933 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1934 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1935 return; 1936 // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to 1937 // mimic gcc's behavior. 1938 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1939 if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1940 return; 1941 } 1942 } 1943 1944 auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD); 1945 if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end()) 1946 return; 1947 1948 assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 && 1949 "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl"); 1950 if (iter->getSecond() != 0) 1951 return; 1952 unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter 1953 : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable; 1954 Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD; 1955 } 1956 1957 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 1958 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 1959 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 1960 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 1961 // MS inline assembly label name. 1962 bool Diagnose = false; 1963 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 1964 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 1965 else 1966 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 1967 if (Diagnose) 1968 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 1969 } 1970 1971 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 1972 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 1973 1974 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 1975 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 1976 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 1977 1978 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 1979 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 1980 1981 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 1982 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 1983 1984 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 1985 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 1986 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 1987 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 1988 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 1989 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1990 DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD); 1991 RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD); 1992 } 1993 } 1994 1995 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 1996 1997 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 1998 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 1999 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 2000 2001 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 2002 // already. 2003 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 2004 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 2005 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 2006 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 2007 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 2008 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 2009 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2010 } 2011 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 2012 } 2013 } 2014 } 2015 2016 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 2017 /// 2018 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 2019 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 2020 /// to the fixed name. 2021 /// 2022 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 2023 /// 2024 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 2025 /// if there is no class with the given name. 2026 /// 2027 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 2028 /// class could not be found. 2029 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 2030 SourceLocation IdLoc, 2031 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 2032 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 2033 // creation from this context. 2034 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 2035 2036 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 2037 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 2038 // find an Objective-C class name. 2039 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 2040 if (TypoCorrection C = 2041 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 2042 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 2043 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 2044 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 2045 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 2046 } 2047 } 2048 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 2049 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 2050 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2051 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2052 return Def; 2053 } 2054 2055 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2056 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2057 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2058 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2059 /// ill-formed in C++: 2060 /// @code 2061 /// struct S6 { 2062 /// enum { BAR } e; 2063 /// }; 2064 /// 2065 /// void test_S6() { 2066 /// struct S6 a; 2067 /// a.e = BAR; 2068 /// } 2069 /// @endcode 2070 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2071 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2072 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2073 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2074 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2075 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2076 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2077 /// contain non-field names. 2078 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2079 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2080 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2081 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2082 S = S->getParent(); 2083 return S; 2084 } 2085 2086 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2087 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2088 switch (Error) { 2089 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2090 return ""; 2091 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2092 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2093 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2094 return "stdio.h"; 2095 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2096 return "setjmp.h"; 2097 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2098 return "ucontext.h"; 2099 } 2100 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2101 } 2102 2103 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2104 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2105 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2106 2107 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2108 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2109 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2110 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2111 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2112 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2113 } 2114 2115 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2116 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, 2117 getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 2118 false, Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2119 New->setImplicit(); 2120 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2121 2122 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2123 // FunctionDecl. 2124 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2125 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2126 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2127 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2128 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2129 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2130 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2131 Params.push_back(parm); 2132 } 2133 New->setParams(Params); 2134 } 2135 2136 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2137 return New; 2138 } 2139 2140 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2141 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2142 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2143 /// built-in. 2144 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2145 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2146 SourceLocation Loc) { 2147 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2148 2149 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2150 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2151 if (Error) { 2152 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2153 return nullptr; 2154 2155 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2156 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2157 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2158 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2159 return nullptr; 2160 2161 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2162 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2163 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2164 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2165 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2166 return nullptr; 2167 } 2168 2169 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2170 // appropriate header. 2171 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2172 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2173 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2174 return nullptr; 2175 } 2176 2177 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2178 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2179 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2180 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2181 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2182 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2183 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2184 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2185 } 2186 2187 if (R.isNull()) 2188 return nullptr; 2189 2190 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2191 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2192 2193 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2194 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2195 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2196 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2197 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2198 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2199 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2200 CurContext = SavedContext; 2201 return New; 2202 } 2203 2204 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2205 /// entity if their types are the same. 2206 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2207 /// isSameEntity. 2208 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2209 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2210 LookupResult &Previous) { 2211 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2212 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2213 return; 2214 2215 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2216 if (Previous.empty()) 2217 return; 2218 2219 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2220 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2221 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2222 2223 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2224 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2225 continue; 2226 2227 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2228 // different linkages. 2229 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2230 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2231 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2232 continue; 2233 2234 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2235 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2236 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2237 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2238 continue; 2239 } 2240 2241 Filter.erase(); 2242 } 2243 2244 Filter.done(); 2245 } 2246 2247 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2248 QualType OldType; 2249 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2250 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2251 else 2252 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2253 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2254 2255 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2256 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2257 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2258 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2259 << Kind << NewType; 2260 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2261 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2262 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2263 return true; 2264 } 2265 2266 if (OldType != NewType && 2267 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2268 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2269 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2270 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2271 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2272 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2273 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2274 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2275 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2276 return true; 2277 } 2278 return false; 2279 } 2280 2281 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2282 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2283 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2284 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2285 /// 2286 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2287 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2288 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2289 // merging checks. 2290 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2291 2292 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2293 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2294 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2295 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2296 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2297 default: break; 2298 case 2: 2299 { 2300 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2301 break; 2302 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2303 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2304 break; 2305 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2306 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2307 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2308 break; 2309 } 2310 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2311 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2312 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2313 return; 2314 } 2315 case 5: 2316 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2317 break; 2318 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2319 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2320 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2321 return; 2322 case 3: 2323 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2324 break; 2325 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2326 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2327 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2328 return; 2329 } 2330 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2331 } 2332 2333 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2334 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2335 if (!Old) { 2336 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2337 << New->getDeclName(); 2338 2339 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2340 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2341 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2342 2343 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2344 } 2345 2346 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2347 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2348 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2349 2350 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2351 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2352 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2353 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2354 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2355 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2356 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2357 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2358 // instead of our tag. 2359 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2360 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2361 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2362 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2363 else 2364 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2365 2366 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2367 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2368 2369 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2370 // out of the scope. 2371 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2372 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2373 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2374 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2375 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2376 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2377 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2378 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2379 } 2380 } 2381 } 2382 } 2383 2384 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2385 // with any extensions enabled. 2386 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2387 return; 2388 2389 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2390 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2391 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2392 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2393 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2394 } 2395 2396 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2397 return; 2398 2399 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2400 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2401 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2402 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2403 // to the type to which it already refers. 2404 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2405 return; 2406 2407 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2408 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2409 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2410 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2411 // 2412 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2413 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2414 // 2415 // struct S { 2416 // typedef struct A { } A; 2417 // }; 2418 // 2419 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2420 // allow the above but disallow 2421 // 2422 // struct S { 2423 // typedef int I; 2424 // typedef int I; 2425 // }; 2426 // 2427 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2428 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2429 return; 2430 2431 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2432 << New->getDeclName(); 2433 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2434 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2435 } 2436 2437 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2438 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2439 return; 2440 2441 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2442 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2443 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2444 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2445 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2446 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2447 (Old->isImplicit() || 2448 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2449 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2450 return; 2451 2452 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2453 << New->getDeclName(); 2454 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2455 } 2456 2457 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2458 /// attribute. 2459 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2460 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2461 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2462 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2463 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2464 if (Ann) { 2465 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2466 return true; 2467 continue; 2468 } 2469 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2470 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2471 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2472 return true; 2473 } 2474 2475 return false; 2476 } 2477 2478 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2479 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2480 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2481 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2482 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2483 return true; 2484 } 2485 2486 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2487 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2488 /// 2489 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2490 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2491 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2492 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2493 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2494 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2495 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2496 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2497 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2498 // in a case like: 2499 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2500 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2501 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2502 // definition in such a case. 2503 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2504 return false; 2505 2506 if (I->isAlignas()) 2507 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2508 2509 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2510 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2511 OldAlign = Align; 2512 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2513 } 2514 } 2515 2516 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2517 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2518 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2519 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2520 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2521 return false; 2522 2523 if (I->isAlignas()) 2524 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2525 2526 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2527 if (Align > NewAlign) 2528 NewAlign = Align; 2529 } 2530 2531 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2532 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2533 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2534 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2535 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2536 2537 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2538 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2539 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2540 QualType Ty; 2541 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2542 Ty = VD->getType(); 2543 else 2544 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2545 2546 if (OldAlign == 0) 2547 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2548 if (NewAlign == 0) 2549 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2550 } 2551 2552 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2553 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2554 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2555 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2556 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2557 } 2558 } 2559 2560 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2561 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2562 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2563 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2564 // equivalent alignment. 2565 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2566 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2567 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2568 // have no alignment specifier. 2569 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2570 << OldAlignasAttr; 2571 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2572 << OldAlignasAttr; 2573 } 2574 2575 bool AnyAdded = false; 2576 2577 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2578 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2579 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2580 Clone->setInherited(true); 2581 New->addAttr(Clone); 2582 AnyAdded = true; 2583 } 2584 2585 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2586 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2587 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2588 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2589 Clone->setInherited(true); 2590 New->addAttr(Clone); 2591 AnyAdded = true; 2592 } 2593 2594 return AnyAdded; 2595 } 2596 2597 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2598 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc" 2599 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC 2600 2601 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2602 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2603 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2604 // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add 2605 // and attributes that already exist on the declaration. 2606 if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr)) 2607 return false; 2608 2609 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2610 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2611 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2612 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2613 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2614 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2615 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2616 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2617 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2618 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2619 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2620 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2621 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2622 AA->getPriority()); 2623 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2624 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2625 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2626 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2627 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2628 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2629 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2630 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2631 else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr)) 2632 NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic()); 2633 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2634 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2635 FA->getFirstArg()); 2636 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2637 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2638 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2639 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2640 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2641 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2642 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2643 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2644 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2645 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2646 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2647 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2648 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2649 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2650 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2651 return false; 2652 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2653 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2654 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2655 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2656 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2657 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2658 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2659 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2660 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2661 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2662 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2663 NewAttr = nullptr; 2664 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2665 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2666 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation || 2667 AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation)) 2668 NewAttr = nullptr; 2669 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2670 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2671 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2672 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2673 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2674 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2675 else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr)) 2676 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA); 2677 else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr)) 2678 NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA); 2679 else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFTagAttr>(Attr)) 2680 NewAttr = S.mergeBTFTagAttr(D, *BTFA); 2681 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2682 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2683 2684 if (NewAttr) { 2685 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2686 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2687 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2688 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2689 return true; 2690 } 2691 2692 return false; 2693 } 2694 2695 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2696 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2697 return TD->getDefinition(); 2698 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2699 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2700 if (Def) 2701 return Def; 2702 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2703 } 2704 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2705 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2706 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2707 return Def; 2708 } 2709 return nullptr; 2710 } 2711 2712 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2713 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2714 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2715 return true; 2716 return false; 2717 } 2718 2719 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2720 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2721 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2722 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2723 return; 2724 2725 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2726 if (!Def || Def == New) 2727 return; 2728 2729 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2730 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2731 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2732 2733 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2734 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2735 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2736 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2737 2738 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2739 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2740 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2741 --E; 2742 continue; 2743 } 2744 } else { 2745 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2746 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2747 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2748 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2749 : diag::err_redefinition; 2750 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2751 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2752 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2753 else 2754 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2755 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2756 } 2757 ++I; 2758 continue; 2759 } 2760 2761 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2762 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2763 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2764 ++I; 2765 continue; 2766 } 2767 } 2768 2769 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2770 ++I; 2771 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2772 } 2773 2774 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2775 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2776 ++I; 2777 continue; 2778 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2779 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2780 ++I; 2781 continue; 2782 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2783 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2784 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2785 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2786 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2787 // equivalent alignment. 2788 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2789 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2790 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2791 // have no alignment specifier. 2792 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2793 << AA; 2794 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2795 << AA; 2796 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2797 --E; 2798 continue; 2799 } 2800 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2801 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 2802 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 2803 // standard diagnostics. 2804 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2805 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2806 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 2807 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2808 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2809 --E; 2810 continue; 2811 } 2812 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 2813 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 2814 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 2815 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 2816 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 2817 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 2818 // honored it. 2819 ++I; 2820 continue; 2821 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2822 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 2823 // declarations after defintions. 2824 ++I; 2825 continue; 2826 } 2827 2828 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2829 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2830 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2831 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2832 --E; 2833 } 2834 } 2835 2836 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 2837 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 2838 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 2839 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 2840 2841 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 2842 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 2843 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 2844 // heroics. 2845 std::string SuitableSpelling; 2846 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2847 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 2848 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 2849 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2850 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2851 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 2852 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 2853 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2854 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 2855 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2856 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2857 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 2858 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2859 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 2860 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2861 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 2862 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2863 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 2864 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2865 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 2866 SuitableSpelling += " "; 2867 2868 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 2869 // extern constinit int a; 2870 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 2871 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 2872 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 2873 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 2874 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 2875 } else { 2876 // int a = 0; 2877 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 2878 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 2879 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 2880 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 2881 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 2882 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 2883 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 2884 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 2885 } 2886 } 2887 2888 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 2889 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 2890 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2891 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 2892 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 2893 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2894 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 2895 } 2896 if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 2897 RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 2898 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2899 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 2900 } 2901 2902 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 2903 return; 2904 2905 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 2906 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 2907 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 2908 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2909 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2910 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 2911 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 2912 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2913 2914 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 2915 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 2916 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 2917 if (!InitDecl && 2918 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 2919 InitDecl = NewVD; 2920 2921 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 2922 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 2923 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 2924 // form). 2925 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 2926 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 2927 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 2928 } else if (NewConstInit) { 2929 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 2930 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 2931 // declaration, this is too late. 2932 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 2933 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 2934 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 2935 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2936 } 2937 } 2938 } 2939 2940 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 2941 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 2942 2943 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 2944 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 2945 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 2946 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 2947 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 2948 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2949 } 2950 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 2951 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 2952 // already been ODR-used. 2953 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 2954 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 2955 } 2956 } 2957 2958 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 2959 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 2960 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 2961 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 2962 if (std::find(OldAbiTagAttr->tags_begin(), OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end(), 2963 NewTag) == OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end()) { 2964 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 2965 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 2966 << NewTag; 2967 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2968 } 2969 } 2970 } else { 2971 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 2972 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2973 } 2974 } 2975 2976 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 2977 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 2978 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 2979 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 2980 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 2981 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2982 } 2983 } 2984 } 2985 2986 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 2987 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 2988 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 2989 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 2990 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 2991 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 2992 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2993 } 2994 2995 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 2996 return; 2997 2998 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 2999 3000 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 3001 // we process them. 3002 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3003 3004 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 3005 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 3006 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 3007 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 3008 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 3009 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 3010 switch (AMK) { 3011 case AMK_None: 3012 continue; 3013 3014 case AMK_Redeclaration: 3015 case AMK_Override: 3016 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 3017 case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation: 3018 LocalAMK = AMK; 3019 break; 3020 } 3021 } 3022 3023 // Already handled. 3024 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I)) 3025 continue; 3026 3027 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 3028 foundAny = true; 3029 } 3030 3031 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 3032 foundAny = true; 3033 3034 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 3035 } 3036 3037 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 3038 /// to the new one. 3039 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 3040 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 3041 Sema &S) { 3042 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3043 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3044 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3045 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3046 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3047 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3048 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3049 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3050 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 3051 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 3052 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 3053 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 3054 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 3055 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 3056 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 3057 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 3058 } 3059 3060 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 3061 return; 3062 3063 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 3064 3065 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 3066 // done before we process them. 3067 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 3068 3069 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3070 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3071 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3072 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3073 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3074 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3075 foundAny = true; 3076 } 3077 } 3078 3079 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3080 } 3081 3082 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3083 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3084 Sema &S) { 3085 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3086 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3087 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3088 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3089 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3090 *Newnullability, 3091 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3092 != 0)) 3093 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3094 *Oldnullability, 3095 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3096 != 0)); 3097 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3098 } 3099 } else { 3100 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3101 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3102 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3103 NewT, NewT); 3104 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3105 } 3106 } 3107 } 3108 3109 namespace { 3110 3111 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3112 /// C. 3113 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3114 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3115 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3116 QualType PromotedType; 3117 }; 3118 3119 } // end anonymous namespace 3120 3121 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3122 // declaration, or a declaration. 3123 template <typename T> 3124 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3125 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3126 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3127 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3128 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3129 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3130 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3131 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3132 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3133 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3134 } else 3135 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3136 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3137 } 3138 3139 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3140 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3141 /// GNU89 mode. 3142 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3143 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3144 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3145 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3146 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3147 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3148 } 3149 3150 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3151 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3152 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3153 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3154 return AT; 3155 } 3156 3157 template <typename T> 3158 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3159 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3160 if (DC->isRecord()) 3161 return false; 3162 3163 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3164 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3165 return true; 3166 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3167 return true; 3168 return false; 3169 } 3170 3171 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3172 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3173 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3174 3175 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3176 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3177 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3178 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3179 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3180 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3181 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3182 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3183 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3184 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3185 // and function templates; or 3186 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3187 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3188 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3189 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3190 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3191 3192 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3193 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3194 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3195 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3196 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3197 3198 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3199 if (Old && 3200 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3201 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3202 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3203 Old = nullptr; 3204 3205 if (!Old) { 3206 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3207 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3208 S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3209 return true; 3210 } 3211 return false; 3212 } 3213 3214 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3215 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3216 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3217 3218 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3219 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3220 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3221 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3222 return true; 3223 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3224 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3225 }; 3226 3227 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3228 } 3229 3230 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3231 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3232 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3233 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3234 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3235 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3236 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3237 // 3238 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3239 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3240 // 3241 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3242 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3243 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3244 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3245 return; 3246 3247 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3248 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3249 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3250 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3251 return; 3252 3253 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3254 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3255 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3256 3257 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3258 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3259 if (!D) 3260 return; 3261 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3262 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3263 }; 3264 3265 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3266 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3267 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3268 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3269 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3270 } 3271 3272 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3273 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3274 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3275 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3276 /// 3277 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3278 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3279 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3280 /// merged with. 3281 /// 3282 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3283 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, 3284 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3285 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3286 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3287 if (!Old) { 3288 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3289 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3290 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3291 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3292 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3293 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 3294 << 0; 3295 return true; 3296 } 3297 3298 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or 3299 // function template. 3300 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = 3301 New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 3302 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, 3303 NewTemplate)) 3304 return true; 3305 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()) 3306 ->getAsFunction(); 3307 } else { 3308 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3309 return true; 3310 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3311 } 3312 } else { 3313 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3314 << New->getDeclName(); 3315 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3316 return true; 3317 } 3318 } 3319 3320 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 3321 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 3322 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 3323 3324 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3325 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3326 return true; 3327 3328 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3329 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3330 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3331 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3332 << Old << Old->getType(); 3333 return true; 3334 } 3335 3336 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3337 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3338 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3339 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3340 3341 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3342 // is an extern inline function. 3343 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3344 // storage classes. 3345 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3346 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3347 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3348 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3349 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3350 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3351 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3352 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3353 } else { 3354 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3355 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3356 return true; 3357 } 3358 } 3359 3360 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 3361 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3362 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3363 << ILA; 3364 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3365 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3366 } 3367 3368 if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3369 if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) { 3370 Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA; 3371 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3372 New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>(); 3373 } 3374 } 3375 3376 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 3377 return true; 3378 3379 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3380 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3381 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3382 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3383 << New << OldOvl; 3384 3385 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3386 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3387 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3388 // 3389 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3390 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3391 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3392 if (OldOvl) { 3393 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3394 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3395 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3396 }); 3397 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3398 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3399 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3400 } 3401 3402 if (DiagOld) 3403 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3404 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3405 << OldOvl; 3406 3407 if (OldOvl) 3408 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3409 else 3410 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3411 } 3412 } 3413 3414 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3415 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3416 // convention of the first. 3417 // 3418 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3419 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3420 // 3421 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3422 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3423 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3424 // 3425 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3426 // other tests to run. 3427 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3428 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3429 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3430 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3431 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3432 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3433 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3434 3435 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3436 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3437 const FunctionType *FT = 3438 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3439 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3440 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3441 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3442 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3443 // there but not here. 3444 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3445 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3446 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3447 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3448 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3449 3450 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3451 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3452 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3453 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3454 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3455 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3456 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3457 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3458 } else { 3459 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3460 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3461 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3462 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3463 << !FirstCCExplicit 3464 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3465 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3466 3467 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3468 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3469 return true; 3470 } 3471 } 3472 3473 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3474 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3475 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3476 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3477 } 3478 3479 // Merge regparm attribute. 3480 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3481 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3482 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3483 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3484 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3485 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3486 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3487 return true; 3488 } 3489 3490 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3491 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3492 } 3493 3494 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3495 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3496 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3497 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3498 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3499 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3500 return true; 3501 } 3502 3503 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3504 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3505 } 3506 3507 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3508 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3509 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3510 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3511 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3512 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3513 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3514 return true; 3515 } 3516 3517 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3518 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3519 } 3520 3521 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3522 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3523 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3524 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3525 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3526 } 3527 3528 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3529 // UndefinedButUsed. 3530 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3531 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3532 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3533 Old->isUsed(false) && 3534 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3535 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3536 SourceLocation())); 3537 3538 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3539 // about it. 3540 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3541 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3542 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3543 } 3544 3545 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3546 // redeclaration. 3547 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3548 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3549 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3550 << New->getDeclName(); 3551 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3552 return true; 3553 } 3554 3555 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3556 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3557 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3558 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3559 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3560 3561 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3562 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3563 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3564 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3565 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3566 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3567 return true; 3568 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3569 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3570 3571 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3572 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3573 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3574 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3575 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3576 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3577 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3578 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3579 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3580 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3581 QualType ResQT; 3582 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3583 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3584 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3585 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3586 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3587 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3588 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3589 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3590 else 3591 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3592 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3593 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3594 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3595 return true; 3596 } 3597 else 3598 NewQType = ResQT; 3599 } 3600 3601 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3602 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3603 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3604 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3605 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3606 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3607 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3608 New->setType( 3609 SubstAutoType(New->getType(), 3610 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 3611 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 3612 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType( 3613 SubstAutoType(NewQType, 3614 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 3615 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 3616 } 3617 } 3618 3619 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3620 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3621 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3622 // Preserve triviality. 3623 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3624 3625 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3626 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3627 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3628 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3629 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3630 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3631 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3632 3633 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3634 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3635 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3636 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3637 // is a static member function declaration. 3638 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3639 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3640 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3641 return true; 3642 } 3643 3644 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3645 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3646 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3647 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3648 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3649 unsigned NewDiag; 3650 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3651 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3652 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3653 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3654 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3655 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3656 else 3657 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3658 3659 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3660 } else { 3661 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3662 << New << New->getType(); 3663 } 3664 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3665 return true; 3666 3667 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3668 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3669 // 3670 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3671 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3672 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3673 if (isFriend) { 3674 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3675 } else { 3676 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3677 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3678 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3679 return true; 3680 } 3681 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3682 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3683 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3684 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3685 return true; 3686 } 3687 } 3688 3689 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3690 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3691 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3692 // attribute. 3693 if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) 3694 if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3695 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 3696 << NRA; 3697 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3698 } 3699 3700 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3701 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3702 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3703 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3704 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3705 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3706 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3707 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3708 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3709 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3710 } 3711 3712 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3713 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3714 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3715 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3716 3717 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3718 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3719 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3720 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3721 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3722 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3723 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3724 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3725 } 3726 3727 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3728 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3729 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3730 // 3731 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3732 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3733 // linkage within class scope. 3734 // 3735 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3736 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3737 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3738 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3739 } else { 3740 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3741 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3742 return true; 3743 } 3744 } 3745 3746 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 3747 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 3748 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 3749 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 3750 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 3751 NewQType)) 3752 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3753 3754 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 3755 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 3756 // during instantiation. 3757 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 3758 return false; 3759 3760 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 3761 } 3762 3763 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 3764 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 3765 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3766 Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 3767 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3768 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3769 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 3770 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 3771 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 3772 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 3773 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 3774 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 3775 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 3776 NewQType = 3777 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 3778 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 3779 New->setType(NewQType); 3780 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 3781 3782 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 3783 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 3784 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 3785 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, New, SourceLocation(), 3786 SourceLocation(), nullptr, 3787 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 3788 SC_None, nullptr); 3789 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 3790 Param->setImplicit(); 3791 Params.push_back(Param); 3792 } 3793 3794 New->setParams(Params); 3795 } 3796 3797 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3798 } 3799 3800 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 3801 // spaces are ignored. 3802 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 3803 return false; 3804 3805 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 3806 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 3807 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 3808 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 3809 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 3810 // the prototype. 3811 // 3812 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 3813 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 3814 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 3815 // C99 6.9.1p8. 3816 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3817 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 3818 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 3819 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 3820 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 3821 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 3822 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 3823 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3824 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 3825 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3826 3827 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 3828 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 3829 NewProto->getReturnType()); 3830 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 3831 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 3832 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 3833 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 3834 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 3835 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3836 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 3837 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3838 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3839 NewParm->getType(), 3840 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 3841 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 3842 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 3843 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 3844 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3845 } else 3846 LooseCompatible = false; 3847 } 3848 3849 if (LooseCompatible) { 3850 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 3851 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 3852 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 3853 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 3854 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 3855 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 3856 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 3857 diag::note_previous_declaration); 3858 } 3859 3860 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 3861 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 3862 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 3863 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3864 } 3865 3866 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 3867 } 3868 3869 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 3870 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 3871 3872 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 3873 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 3874 unsigned BuiltinID; 3875 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 3876 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 3877 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 3878 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 3879 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 3880 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3881 << Old << Old->getType(); 3882 return false; 3883 } 3884 3885 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3886 } 3887 3888 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 3889 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3890 return true; 3891 } 3892 3893 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 3894 /// known to be compatible. 3895 /// 3896 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 3897 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 3898 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 3899 /// redeclaration of Old. 3900 /// 3901 /// \returns false 3902 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 3903 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3904 // Merge the attributes 3905 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 3906 3907 // Merge "pure" flag. 3908 if (Old->isPure()) 3909 New->setPure(); 3910 3911 // Merge "used" flag. 3912 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 3913 New->setIsUsed(); 3914 3915 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 3916 // declarations. 3917 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 3918 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 3919 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 3920 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 3921 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3922 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3923 } 3924 3925 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3926 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 3927 3928 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 3929 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 3930 // was visible. 3931 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 3932 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 3933 New->setType(Merged); 3934 3935 return false; 3936 } 3937 3938 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 3939 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 3940 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 3941 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 3942 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 3943 ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation 3944 : AMK_ProtocolImplementation) 3945 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 3946 : AMK_Override; 3947 3948 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 3949 3950 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 3951 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 3952 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 3953 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 3954 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 3955 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 3956 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 3957 3958 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 3959 } 3960 3961 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 3962 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 3963 3964 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 3965 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 3966 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 3967 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 3968 3969 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3970 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3971 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 3972 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3973 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3974 New->setInvalidDecl(); 3975 } 3976 3977 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 3978 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 3979 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3980 /// 3981 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 3982 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 3983 /// is attached. 3984 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 3985 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3986 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3987 return; 3988 3989 QualType MergedT; 3990 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3991 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 3992 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 3993 return; 3994 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 3995 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 3996 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 3997 } 3998 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 3999 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 4000 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 4001 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 4002 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 4003 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 4004 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 4005 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 4006 4007 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 4008 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 4009 // mismatch. 4010 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 4011 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 4012 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 4013 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 4014 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 4015 continue; 4016 4017 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 4018 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 4019 } 4020 } 4021 4022 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 4023 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4024 NewArray->getElementType())) 4025 MergedT = New->getType(); 4026 } 4027 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 4028 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 4029 // visible. 4030 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 4031 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 4032 NewArray->getElementType())) 4033 MergedT = Old->getType(); 4034 } 4035 } 4036 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4037 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4038 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 4039 Old->getType()); 4040 } 4041 } else { 4042 // C 6.2.7p2: 4043 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 4044 // compatible type. 4045 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 4046 } 4047 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 4048 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 4049 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 4050 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 4051 // equivalent. 4052 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 4053 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 4054 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 4055 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 4056 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 4057 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 4058 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 4059 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 4060 return; 4061 } 4062 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 4063 } 4064 4065 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 4066 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 4067 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 4068 New->setType(MergedT); 4069 } 4070 4071 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 4072 LookupResult &Previous) { 4073 // C11 6.2.7p4: 4074 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 4075 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 4076 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 4077 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 4078 // declaration becomes the composite type. 4079 // 4080 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 4081 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 4082 return false; 4083 4084 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4085 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 4086 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 4087 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 4088 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 4089 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 4090 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4091 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 4092 } else { 4093 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4094 // type unless we're in the same function. 4095 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4096 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4097 } 4098 } 4099 4100 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4101 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4102 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4103 /// 4104 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4105 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4106 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4107 /// 4108 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4109 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4110 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4111 return; 4112 4113 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4114 return; 4115 4116 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4117 4118 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4119 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4120 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4121 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4122 if (NewTemplate) { 4123 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4124 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4125 4126 if (auto *Shadow = 4127 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4128 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4129 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4130 } else { 4131 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4132 4133 if (auto *Shadow = 4134 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4135 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4136 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4137 } 4138 } 4139 if (!Old) { 4140 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4141 << New->getDeclName(); 4142 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4143 New->getLocation()); 4144 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4145 } 4146 4147 // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new 4148 // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match. 4149 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4150 4151 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4152 if (NewTemplate && 4153 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4154 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4155 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4156 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4157 4158 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4159 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4160 // 4161 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4162 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4163 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4164 << New->getIdentifier(); 4165 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4166 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4167 } 4168 4169 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4170 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4171 // declaration 4172 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4173 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4174 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4175 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4176 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4177 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4178 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4179 } 4180 4181 if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) 4182 if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4183 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) 4184 << ILA; 4185 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4186 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4187 } 4188 4189 // Merge the types. 4190 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4191 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4192 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4193 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4194 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4195 return; 4196 } 4197 4198 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4199 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4200 return; 4201 4202 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4203 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4204 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4205 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4206 4207 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4208 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4209 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4210 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4211 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4212 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4213 << New->getDeclName(); 4214 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4215 } else { 4216 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4217 << New->getDeclName(); 4218 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4219 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4220 } 4221 } 4222 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4223 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4224 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4225 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4226 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4227 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4228 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4229 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4230 // identifier has external linkage. 4231 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4232 /* Okay */; 4233 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4234 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4235 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4236 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4237 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4238 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4239 } 4240 4241 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4242 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4243 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4244 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4245 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4246 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4247 } 4248 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4249 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4250 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4251 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4252 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4253 } 4254 4255 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 4256 return; 4257 4258 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4259 4260 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4261 // need to check for mismatches. 4262 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4263 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4264 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4265 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4266 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4267 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4268 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4269 } 4270 4271 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4272 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4273 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4274 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4275 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4276 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4277 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4278 } 4279 } 4280 4281 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4282 // UndefinedButUsed. 4283 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4284 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4285 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4286 SourceLocation())); 4287 4288 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4289 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4290 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4291 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4292 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4293 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4294 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4295 } else { 4296 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4297 // static and dynamic initialization. 4298 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4299 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4300 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4301 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4302 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4303 } 4304 } 4305 4306 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4307 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4308 New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4309 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4310 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4311 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4312 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4313 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4314 } else if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4315 if (checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4316 return; 4317 } 4318 } 4319 4320 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4321 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4322 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4323 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4324 return; 4325 } 4326 4327 // Merge "used" flag. 4328 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4329 New->setIsUsed(); 4330 4331 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4332 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4333 if (NewTemplate) 4334 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4335 4336 // Inherit access appropriately. 4337 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4338 if (NewTemplate) 4339 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4340 4341 if (Old->isInline()) 4342 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4343 } 4344 4345 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4346 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4347 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4348 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4349 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4350 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4351 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4352 StringRef HdrFilename = 4353 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4354 4355 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4356 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4357 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4358 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4359 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4360 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4361 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4362 if (Mod) { 4363 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4364 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4365 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4366 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4367 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4368 } else { 4369 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4370 << HdrFilename.str(); 4371 } 4372 return true; 4373 } 4374 4375 return false; 4376 }; 4377 4378 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4379 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4380 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4381 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4382 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4383 bool EmittedDiag = 4384 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4385 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4386 4387 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4388 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4389 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4390 4391 if (EmittedDiag) 4392 return; 4393 } 4394 4395 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4396 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4397 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4398 } 4399 4400 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4401 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4402 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4403 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4404 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4405 New->isInline() || 4406 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4407 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4408 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4409 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4410 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4411 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4412 4413 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4414 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4415 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4416 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4417 return false; 4418 } else { 4419 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4420 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4421 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4422 return true; 4423 } 4424 } 4425 4426 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4427 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4428 Decl * 4429 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4430 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4431 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, 4432 AnonRecord); 4433 } 4434 4435 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4436 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4437 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4438 // compatibility. 4439 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4440 // targeted. 4441 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4442 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4443 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4444 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4445 } 4446 4447 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4448 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4449 return; 4450 4451 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4452 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4453 // it is anonymous. 4454 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4455 return; 4456 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4457 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4458 Context.setManglingNumber( 4459 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4460 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4461 return; 4462 } 4463 4464 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4465 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4466 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4467 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4468 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4469 if (MCtx) { 4470 Context.setManglingNumber( 4471 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4472 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4473 } 4474 } 4475 4476 namespace { 4477 struct NonCLikeKind { 4478 enum { 4479 None, 4480 BaseClass, 4481 DefaultMemberInit, 4482 Lambda, 4483 Friend, 4484 OtherMember, 4485 Invalid, 4486 } Kind = None; 4487 SourceRange Range; 4488 4489 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4490 }; 4491 } 4492 4493 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4494 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4495 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4496 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4497 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4498 4499 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4500 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4501 // 4502 // -- have any base classes 4503 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4504 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4505 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4506 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4507 bool Invalid = false; 4508 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4509 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4510 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4511 Invalid = true; 4512 continue; 4513 } 4514 4515 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4516 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4517 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4518 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4519 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4520 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4521 } 4522 continue; 4523 } 4524 4525 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4526 // P1766, but not the intent. 4527 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4528 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4529 4530 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4531 // enumerations, or member classes, 4532 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4533 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4534 continue; 4535 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4536 if (!MemberRD) { 4537 if (D->isImplicit()) 4538 continue; 4539 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4540 } 4541 4542 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4543 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4544 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4545 4546 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4547 // (recursively). 4548 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4549 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4550 return Kind; 4551 } 4552 } 4553 4554 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4555 } 4556 4557 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4558 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4559 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4560 return; 4561 4562 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4563 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4564 return; 4565 4566 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4567 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4568 4569 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4570 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4571 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4572 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4573 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4574 return; 4575 } 4576 4577 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4578 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4579 // C-like]. 4580 // 4581 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4582 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4583 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4584 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4585 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4586 : NonCLikeKind(); 4587 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4588 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4589 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4590 return; 4591 4592 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4593 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4594 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4595 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4596 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4597 else 4598 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4599 } 4600 4601 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4602 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4603 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4604 TextToInsert += ' '; 4605 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4606 4607 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4608 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4609 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4610 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4611 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4612 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4613 } 4614 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4615 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4616 4617 if (ChangesLinkage) 4618 return; 4619 } 4620 4621 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4622 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4623 } 4624 4625 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4626 switch (T) { 4627 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4628 return 0; 4629 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4630 return 1; 4631 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4632 return 2; 4633 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4634 return 3; 4635 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4636 return 4; 4637 default: 4638 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4639 } 4640 } 4641 4642 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4643 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4644 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4645 Decl * 4646 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4647 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4648 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4649 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4650 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4651 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4652 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4653 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4654 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4655 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4656 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4657 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4658 4659 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4660 return nullptr; 4661 4662 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4663 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4664 // it's a Type. 4665 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4666 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4667 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4668 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4669 } 4670 4671 if (Tag) { 4672 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 4673 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 4674 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 4675 return Tag; 4676 } 4677 4678 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4679 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 4680 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 4681 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4682 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4683 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 4684 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4685 } 4686 4687 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 4688 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 4689 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 4690 4691 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 4692 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 4693 // and definitions of functions and variables. 4694 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 4695 // the declaration of a function or function template 4696 if (Tag) 4697 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 4698 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 4699 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4700 else 4701 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 4702 << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier()); 4703 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 4704 return TagD; 4705 } 4706 4707 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 4708 4709 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 4710 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 4711 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 4712 if (TagD && !Tag) 4713 return nullptr; 4714 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 4715 } 4716 4717 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 4718 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 4719 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 4720 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 4721 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 4722 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 4723 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 4724 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 4725 // or an explicit specialization. 4726 // 4727 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 4728 // obvious intent of DR1819. 4729 // 4730 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 4731 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 4732 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 4733 return nullptr; 4734 } 4735 4736 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 4737 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 4738 4739 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 4740 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 4741 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 4742 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4743 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 4744 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 4745 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 4746 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 4747 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 4748 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 4749 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 4750 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 4751 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 4752 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4753 AnonRecord = Record; 4754 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 4755 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4756 } 4757 4758 DeclaresAnything = false; 4759 } 4760 } 4761 4762 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 4763 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 4764 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 4765 // 4766 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 4767 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 4768 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 4769 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 4770 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 4771 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 4772 // struct STRUCT; 4773 // union UNION; 4774 // and 4775 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 4776 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 4777 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 4778 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 4779 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 4780 if (Tag) 4781 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 4782 else if (const RecordType *RT = 4783 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 4784 Record = RT->getDecl(); 4785 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 4786 Record = UT->getDecl(); 4787 4788 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4789 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 4790 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 4791 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 4792 } 4793 4794 DeclaresAnything = false; 4795 } 4796 } 4797 4798 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 4799 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 4800 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 4801 return TagD; 4802 4803 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4804 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4805 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 4806 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 4807 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 4808 DeclaresAnything = false; 4809 4810 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 4811 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 4812 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4813 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 4814 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4815 else 4816 DeclaresAnything = false; 4817 } 4818 4819 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 4820 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4821 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 4822 << Tag->getTagKind() 4823 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 4824 4825 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 4826 4827 // C 6.7/2: 4828 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 4829 // or the members of an enumeration. 4830 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 4831 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 4832 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 4833 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 4834 // previous declaration. 4835 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 4836 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 4837 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 4838 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 4839 ? diag::err_no_declarators 4840 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 4841 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4842 return TagD; 4843 } 4844 4845 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 4846 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 4847 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 4848 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 4849 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 4850 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 4851 // 4852 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 4853 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 4854 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4855 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 4856 4857 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 4858 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 4859 // useless. 4860 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 4861 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 4862 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 4863 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 4864 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 4865 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4866 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 4867 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 4868 } 4869 4870 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 4871 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 4872 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 4873 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4874 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 4875 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 4876 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 4877 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 4878 // Restrict is covered above. 4879 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 4880 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 4881 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 4882 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 4883 } 4884 4885 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 4886 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 4887 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 4888 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) { 4889 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 4890 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4891 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4892 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4893 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4894 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4895 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 4896 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 4897 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 4898 } 4899 } 4900 4901 return TagD; 4902 } 4903 4904 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 4905 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 4906 /// 4907 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 4908 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 4909 Scope *S, 4910 DeclContext *Owner, 4911 DeclarationName Name, 4912 SourceLocation NameLoc, 4913 bool IsUnion) { 4914 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 4915 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 4916 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 4917 4918 // Pick a representative declaration. 4919 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 4920 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 4921 4922 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 4923 return false; 4924 4925 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 4926 << IsUnion << Name; 4927 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4928 4929 return true; 4930 } 4931 4932 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 4933 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 4934 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 4935 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 4936 /// struct, e.g., 4937 /// 4938 /// @code 4939 /// union { 4940 /// int i; 4941 /// float f; 4942 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 4943 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 4944 /// @endcode 4945 /// 4946 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 4947 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 4948 static bool 4949 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 4950 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 4951 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 4952 bool Invalid = false; 4953 4954 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 4955 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 4956 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 4957 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 4958 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 4959 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 4960 VD->getLocation(), 4961 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 4962 // C++ [class.union]p2: 4963 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 4964 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 4965 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 4966 Invalid = true; 4967 } else { 4968 // C++ [class.union]p2: 4969 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 4970 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 4971 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 4972 // anonymous union is declared. 4973 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 4974 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 4975 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 4976 else 4977 Chaining.push_back(VD); 4978 4979 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 4980 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 4981 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 4982 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 4983 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 4984 4985 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 4986 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 4987 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 4988 4989 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 4990 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 4991 4992 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 4993 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 4994 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 4995 4996 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 4997 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 4998 4999 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 5000 } 5001 } 5002 } 5003 5004 return Invalid; 5005 } 5006 5007 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 5008 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 5009 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 5010 static StorageClass 5011 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5012 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5013 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5014 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 5015 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 5016 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 5017 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 5018 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 5019 return SC_None; 5020 return SC_Extern; 5021 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 5022 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 5023 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 5024 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 5025 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 5026 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 5027 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 5028 } 5029 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 5030 } 5031 5032 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 5033 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 5034 5035 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 5036 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 5037 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 5038 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 5039 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 5040 return FD->getLocation(); 5041 } 5042 5043 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 5044 } 5045 5046 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5047 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 5048 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5049 return; 5050 5051 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 5052 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 5053 } 5054 5055 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 5056 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 5057 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 5058 return; 5059 5060 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 5061 } 5062 5063 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 5064 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 5065 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 5066 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 5067 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5068 AccessSpecifier AS, 5069 RecordDecl *Record, 5070 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 5071 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 5072 5073 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 5074 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 5075 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 5076 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5077 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 5078 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 5079 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 5080 5081 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 5082 // structs/unions. 5083 bool Invalid = false; 5084 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5085 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 5086 if (Record->isUnion()) { 5087 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5088 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 5089 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 5090 // global namespace shall be declared static. 5091 unsigned DiagID; 5092 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 5093 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 5094 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 5095 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 5096 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5097 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5098 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5099 5100 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5101 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5102 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5103 } 5104 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5105 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5106 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5107 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5108 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5109 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5110 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5111 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5112 5113 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5114 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5115 SourceLocation(), 5116 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5117 } 5118 } 5119 5120 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5121 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5122 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5123 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5124 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5125 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5126 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5127 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5128 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5129 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5130 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5131 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5132 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5133 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5134 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5135 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5136 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5137 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5138 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5139 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5140 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5141 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5142 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5143 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5144 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5145 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5146 5147 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5148 } 5149 5150 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5151 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5152 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5153 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5154 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5155 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5156 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5157 continue; 5158 5159 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5160 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5161 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5162 // members (clause 11). 5163 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5164 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5165 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5166 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5167 Invalid = true; 5168 } 5169 5170 // C++ [class.union]p1 5171 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5172 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5173 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5174 // array of such objects. 5175 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5176 Invalid = true; 5177 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5178 // Any implicit members are fine. 5179 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5180 // This is a type that showed up in an 5181 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5182 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5183 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5184 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5185 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5186 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5187 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5188 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5189 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5190 << Record->isUnion(); 5191 else { 5192 // This is a nested type declaration. 5193 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5194 << Record->isUnion(); 5195 Invalid = true; 5196 } 5197 } else { 5198 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5199 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5200 // not part of standard C++. 5201 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5202 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5203 << Record->isUnion(); 5204 } 5205 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5206 // Any access specifier is fine. 5207 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5208 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5209 } else { 5210 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5211 // member. Complain about it. 5212 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5213 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5214 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5215 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5216 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5217 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5218 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5219 5220 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5221 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5222 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5223 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5224 << Record->isUnion(); 5225 else { 5226 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5227 Invalid = true; 5228 } 5229 } 5230 } 5231 5232 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5233 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5234 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5235 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5236 Owner->isRecord()) 5237 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5238 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5239 } 5240 5241 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5242 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5243 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5244 Invalid = true; 5245 } 5246 5247 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5248 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5249 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5250 // names into the program 5251 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5252 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5253 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5254 // 5255 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5256 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5257 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5258 5259 // Mock up a declarator. 5260 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::Member); 5261 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5262 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5263 5264 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5265 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5266 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5267 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5268 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5269 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5270 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5271 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5272 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5273 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5274 5275 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5276 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5277 } else { 5278 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5279 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5280 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5281 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5282 // an error here 5283 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5284 Invalid = true; 5285 SC = SC_None; 5286 } 5287 5288 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5289 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5290 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5291 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5292 5293 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5294 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5295 // initializer: 5296 // union { int n = 0; }; 5297 if (!Invalid) 5298 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5299 } 5300 Anon->setImplicit(); 5301 5302 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5303 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5304 5305 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5306 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5307 // its members. 5308 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5309 5310 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5311 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5312 // purposes. 5313 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5314 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5315 5316 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5317 Invalid = true; 5318 5319 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5320 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5321 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5322 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5323 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5324 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5325 if (MCtx) { 5326 Context.setManglingNumber( 5327 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5328 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5329 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5330 } 5331 } 5332 } 5333 5334 if (Invalid) 5335 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5336 5337 return Anon; 5338 } 5339 5340 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5341 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5342 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5343 /// Example: 5344 /// 5345 /// struct A { int a; }; 5346 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5347 /// 5348 /// void foo() { 5349 /// B var; 5350 /// var.a = 3; 5351 /// } 5352 /// 5353 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5354 RecordDecl *Record) { 5355 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5356 5357 // Mock up a declarator. 5358 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::TypeName); 5359 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5360 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5361 5362 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5363 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5364 5365 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5366 NamedDecl *Anon = 5367 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5368 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5369 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5370 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5371 Anon->setImplicit(); 5372 5373 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5374 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5375 5376 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5377 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5378 // purposes. 5379 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5380 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5381 5382 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5383 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5384 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5385 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5386 AS_none, Chain)) { 5387 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5388 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5389 } 5390 5391 return Anon; 5392 } 5393 5394 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5395 /// given Declarator. 5396 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5397 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5398 } 5399 5400 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5401 DeclarationNameInfo 5402 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5403 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5404 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5405 5406 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5407 5408 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5409 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5410 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5411 return NameInfo; 5412 5413 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5414 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5415 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5416 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5417 // of the simple-template-id. 5418 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5419 // class template. 5420 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5421 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5422 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5423 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5424 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5425 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5426 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5427 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5428 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5429 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5430 if (Template) 5431 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5432 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5433 } 5434 5435 NameInfo.setName( 5436 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5437 return NameInfo; 5438 } 5439 5440 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5441 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5442 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5443 NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange( 5444 Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation)); 5445 return NameInfo; 5446 5447 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5448 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5449 Name.Identifier)); 5450 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5451 return NameInfo; 5452 5453 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5454 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5455 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5456 if (Ty.isNull()) 5457 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5458 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5459 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5460 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5461 return NameInfo; 5462 } 5463 5464 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5465 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5466 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5467 if (Ty.isNull()) 5468 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5469 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5470 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5471 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5472 return NameInfo; 5473 } 5474 5475 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5476 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5477 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5478 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5479 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5480 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5481 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5482 5483 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5484 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5485 5486 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5487 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5488 // was qualified. 5489 5490 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5491 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5492 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5493 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5494 return NameInfo; 5495 } 5496 5497 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5498 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5499 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5500 if (Ty.isNull()) 5501 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5502 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5503 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5504 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5505 return NameInfo; 5506 } 5507 5508 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5509 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5510 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5511 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5512 } 5513 5514 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5515 5516 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5517 } 5518 5519 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5520 do { 5521 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5522 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5523 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5524 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5525 else 5526 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5527 } while (true); 5528 } 5529 5530 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5531 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5532 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5533 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5534 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5535 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5536 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5537 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5538 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5539 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5540 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5541 Params.clear(); 5542 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5543 return false; 5544 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5545 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5546 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5547 5548 // The parameter types are identical 5549 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5550 continue; 5551 5552 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5553 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5554 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5555 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5556 5557 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5558 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5559 Params.push_back(Idx); 5560 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5561 return false; 5562 } 5563 5564 return true; 5565 } 5566 5567 /// NeedsRebuildingInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5568 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5569 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5570 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5571 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5572 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5573 DeclarationName Name) { 5574 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5575 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5576 // - types which will become injected class names 5577 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5578 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5579 // few cases here. 5580 5581 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5582 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5583 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5584 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5585 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5586 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5587 // Grab the type from the parser. 5588 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5589 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5590 if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break; 5591 5592 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5593 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5594 // attached already. 5595 if (!TSI) 5596 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5597 5598 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5599 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5600 if (!TSI) return true; 5601 5602 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5603 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5604 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5605 break; 5606 } 5607 5608 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5609 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5610 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5611 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5612 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5613 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5614 break; 5615 } 5616 5617 default: 5618 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5619 break; 5620 } 5621 5622 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5623 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5624 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5625 5626 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5627 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5628 // pointer. 5629 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5630 continue; 5631 5632 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5633 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5634 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5635 return true; 5636 } 5637 5638 return false; 5639 } 5640 5641 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) { 5642 // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration 5643 // of system decl. 5644 if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit()) 5645 return; 5646 ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts()); 5647 if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved && 5648 !Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation())) 5649 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol) 5650 << D << static_cast<int>(Status); 5651 } 5652 5653 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5654 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration); 5655 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 5656 5657 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 5658 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 5659 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 5660 5661 return Dcl; 5662 } 5663 5664 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 5665 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 5666 /// name different from T: 5667 /// - every static data member of class T; 5668 /// - every member function of class T 5669 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 5670 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 5671 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 5672 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 5673 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5674 5675 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 5676 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 5677 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 5678 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 5679 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 5680 return true; 5681 } 5682 5683 return false; 5684 } 5685 5686 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 5687 /// nested-name-specifier. 5688 /// 5689 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5690 /// 5691 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 5692 /// resolves. 5693 /// 5694 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 5695 /// 5696 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 5697 /// 5698 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 5699 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 5700 /// 5701 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 5702 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 5703 DeclarationName Name, 5704 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 5705 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 5706 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 5707 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 5708 5709 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 5710 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 5711 // 5712 // class X { 5713 // void X::f(); 5714 // }; 5715 // 5716 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 5717 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 5718 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 5719 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5720 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 5721 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 5722 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 5723 SS.clear(); 5724 } else { 5725 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 5726 } 5727 return false; 5728 } 5729 5730 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 5731 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 5732 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 5733 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 5734 if (Cur->isRecord()) 5735 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5736 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5737 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 5738 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 5739 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5740 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 5741 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 5742 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5743 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 5744 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 5745 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5746 else 5747 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 5748 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 5749 5750 return true; 5751 } 5752 5753 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5754 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 5755 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5756 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5757 SS.clear(); 5758 5759 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 5760 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 5761 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 5762 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 5763 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 5764 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 5765 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 5766 return true; 5767 5768 return false; 5769 } 5770 5771 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 5772 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 5773 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 5774 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 5775 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 5776 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 5777 if (dyn_cast_or_null<DecltypeType>( 5778 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 5779 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 5780 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 5781 5782 return false; 5783 } 5784 5785 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 5786 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 5787 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 5788 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 5789 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5790 5791 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 5792 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 5793 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 5794 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 5795 } else if (!Name) { 5796 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 5797 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 5798 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 5799 return nullptr; 5800 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 5801 return nullptr; 5802 5803 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 5804 // we find one that is. 5805 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 5806 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 5807 S = S->getParent(); 5808 5809 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 5810 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 5811 D.setInvalidType(); 5812 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 5813 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 5814 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 5815 return nullptr; 5816 5817 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 5818 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 5819 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 5820 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 5821 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 5822 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 5823 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 5824 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5825 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 5826 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 5827 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 5828 return nullptr; 5829 } 5830 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 5831 5832 if (!IsDependentContext && 5833 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 5834 return nullptr; 5835 5836 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 5837 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 5838 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5839 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 5840 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 5841 return nullptr; 5842 } 5843 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 5844 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 5845 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5846 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 5847 if (DC->isRecord()) 5848 return nullptr; 5849 5850 D.setInvalidType(); 5851 } 5852 } 5853 5854 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 5855 // declaration in the current instantiation. 5856 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 5857 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 5858 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 5859 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 5860 D.setInvalidType(); 5861 } 5862 } 5863 5864 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 5865 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 5866 5867 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 5868 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 5869 D.setInvalidType(); 5870 5871 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 5872 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 5873 5874 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 5875 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 5876 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 5877 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 5878 5879 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 5880 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 5881 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 5882 // 5883 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 5884 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 5885 // the same name. 5886 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5887 /* Do nothing*/; 5888 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 5889 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 5890 R->isFunctionType())) { 5891 IsLinkageLookup = true; 5892 CreateBuiltins = 5893 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 5894 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 5895 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 5896 CreateBuiltins = true; 5897 5898 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 5899 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 5900 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 5901 } 5902 5903 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 5904 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 5905 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 5906 5907 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 5908 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 5909 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 5910 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 5911 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 5912 // thereof; [...] 5913 // 5914 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 5915 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 5916 // we want to match. For example, given: 5917 // 5918 // class X { 5919 // void f(); 5920 // void f(float); 5921 // }; 5922 // 5923 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 5924 // 5925 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 5926 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 5927 // matches. 5928 5929 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 5930 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 5931 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 5932 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5933 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 5934 } 5935 5936 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 5937 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 5938 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 5939 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 5940 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5941 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 5942 5943 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 5944 Previous.clear(); 5945 } 5946 5947 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 5948 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 5949 Previous.clear(); 5950 5951 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 5952 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 5953 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 5954 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 5955 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 5956 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5957 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 5958 Previous.clear(); 5959 5960 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 5961 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 5962 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5963 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 5964 5965 NamedDecl *New; 5966 5967 bool AddToScope = true; 5968 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 5969 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 5970 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 5971 return nullptr; 5972 } 5973 5974 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 5975 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 5976 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 5977 TemplateParamLists, 5978 AddToScope); 5979 } else { 5980 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 5981 AddToScope); 5982 } 5983 5984 if (!New) 5985 return nullptr; 5986 5987 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 5988 // add it to the scope stack. 5989 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 5990 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 5991 5992 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 5993 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 5994 5995 return New; 5996 } 5997 5998 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 5999 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6000 /// GCC compatibility). 6001 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 6002 ASTContext &Context, 6003 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6004 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6005 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 6006 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 6007 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 6008 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 6009 SizeIsNegative = false; 6010 Oversized = 0; 6011 6012 if (T->isDependentType()) 6013 return QualType(); 6014 6015 QualifierCollector Qs; 6016 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 6017 6018 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 6019 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 6020 QualType FixedType = 6021 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6022 Oversized); 6023 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6024 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 6025 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6026 } 6027 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 6028 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 6029 QualType FixedType = 6030 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 6031 Oversized); 6032 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 6033 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 6034 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 6035 } 6036 6037 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 6038 if (!VLATy) 6039 return QualType(); 6040 6041 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 6042 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6043 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 6044 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6045 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 6046 return QualType(); 6047 } 6048 6049 Expr::EvalResult Result; 6050 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 6051 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 6052 return QualType(); 6053 6054 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 6055 6056 // Check whether the array size is negative. 6057 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 6058 SizeIsNegative = true; 6059 return QualType(); 6060 } 6061 6062 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 6063 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 6064 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 6065 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 6066 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 6067 : Res.getActiveBits(); 6068 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 6069 Oversized = Res; 6070 return QualType(); 6071 } 6072 6073 QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType( 6074 ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 6075 return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType); 6076 } 6077 6078 static void 6079 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 6080 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6081 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 6082 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 6083 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 6084 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 6085 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 6086 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 6087 return; 6088 } 6089 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 6090 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 6091 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 6092 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 6093 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 6094 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 6095 return; 6096 } 6097 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6098 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 6099 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 6100 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 6101 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 6102 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 6103 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 6104 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 6105 } else { 6106 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6107 } 6108 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6109 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6110 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6111 } 6112 6113 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6114 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6115 /// GCC compatibility). 6116 static TypeSourceInfo* 6117 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6118 ASTContext &Context, 6119 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6120 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6121 QualType FixedTy 6122 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6123 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6124 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6125 return nullptr; 6126 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6127 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6128 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6129 return FixedTInfo; 6130 } 6131 6132 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning 6133 /// true if we were successful. 6134 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, 6135 QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, 6136 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) { 6137 bool SizeIsNegative; 6138 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6139 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 6140 TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6141 if (FixedTInfo) { 6142 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6143 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 6144 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 6145 return true; 6146 } 6147 6148 if (SizeIsNegative) 6149 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6150 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6151 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10); 6152 else if (FailedFoldDiagID) 6153 Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID); 6154 return false; 6155 } 6156 6157 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6158 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6159 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6160 /// function-scope declarations. 6161 void 6162 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6163 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6164 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6165 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6166 return; 6167 6168 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6169 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6170 } 6171 6172 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6173 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6174 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6175 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6176 } 6177 6178 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6179 /// does not identify a function. 6180 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6181 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6182 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6183 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6184 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6185 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6186 6187 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6188 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6189 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6190 6191 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6192 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6193 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6194 } 6195 6196 NamedDecl* 6197 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6198 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6199 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6200 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6201 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6202 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6203 D.setInvalidType(); 6204 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6205 DC = CurContext; 6206 Previous.clear(); 6207 } 6208 6209 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6210 6211 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6212 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6213 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6214 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6215 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6216 << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 6217 6218 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6219 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6220 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6221 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6222 << "typedef"; 6223 else 6224 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6225 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6226 return nullptr; 6227 } 6228 6229 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6230 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6231 6232 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6233 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6234 6235 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6236 6237 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6238 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6239 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6240 return ND; 6241 } 6242 6243 void 6244 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6245 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6246 // then it shall have block scope. 6247 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6248 // that redeclarations will match. 6249 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6250 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6251 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6252 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6253 6254 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6255 bool SizeIsNegative; 6256 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6257 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6258 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6259 SizeIsNegative, 6260 Oversized); 6261 if (FixedTInfo) { 6262 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6263 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6264 } else { 6265 if (SizeIsNegative) 6266 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6267 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6268 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6269 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6270 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6271 << toString(Oversized, 10); 6272 else 6273 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6274 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6275 } 6276 } 6277 } 6278 } 6279 6280 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6281 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6282 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6283 NamedDecl* 6284 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6285 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6286 6287 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6288 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6289 6290 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6291 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6292 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6293 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6294 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6295 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6296 Redeclaration = true; 6297 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6298 } else { 6299 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6300 } 6301 6302 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6303 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6304 6305 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6306 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6307 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6308 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6309 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6310 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6311 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6312 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6313 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6314 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6315 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6316 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6317 } 6318 6319 return NewTD; 6320 } 6321 6322 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6323 /// previous declaration. 6324 /// 6325 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6326 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6327 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6328 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6329 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6330 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6331 /// 6332 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6333 /// lookup 6334 /// 6335 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6336 /// declared. 6337 /// 6338 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6339 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6340 static bool 6341 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6342 ASTContext &Context) { 6343 if (!PrevDecl) 6344 return false; 6345 6346 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6347 return false; 6348 6349 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6350 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6351 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6352 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6353 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6354 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6355 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6356 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6357 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6358 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6359 return false; 6360 6361 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6362 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6363 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6364 return false; 6365 6366 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6367 // previous declarations. 6368 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6369 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6370 6371 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6372 // isn't the same function. 6373 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6374 return false; 6375 } 6376 6377 return true; 6378 } 6379 6380 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6381 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6382 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6383 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6384 } 6385 6386 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6387 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6388 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6389 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6390 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6391 unsigned kind = -1U; 6392 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6393 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6394 kind = 0; // __block 6395 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6396 kind = 1; // global 6397 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6398 kind = 3; // ivar 6399 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6400 kind = 2; // field 6401 } 6402 6403 if (kind != -1U) { 6404 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6405 << kind; 6406 } 6407 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6408 // Try to infer lifetime. 6409 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6410 return false; 6411 6412 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6413 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6414 decl->setType(type); 6415 } 6416 6417 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6418 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6419 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6420 var->getTLSKind()) { 6421 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6422 << var->getType(); 6423 return true; 6424 } 6425 } 6426 6427 return false; 6428 } 6429 6430 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6431 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6432 return; 6433 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6434 return; 6435 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6436 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6437 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6438 return; 6439 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6440 // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the 6441 // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space 6442 // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside 6443 // a function are inferred to be __global. 6444 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) && 6445 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6446 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6447 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6448 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6449 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6450 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6451 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6452 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6453 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6454 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6455 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6456 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6457 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6458 } 6459 } 6460 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6461 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6462 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6463 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6464 // qualified, not the array type." 6465 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6466 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6467 Decl->setType(Type); 6468 } 6469 } 6470 6471 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6472 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6473 // the wrong linkage. 6474 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6475 6476 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6477 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6478 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6479 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6480 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6481 } 6482 } 6483 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6484 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6485 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6486 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6487 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6488 } 6489 } 6490 6491 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6492 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6493 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6494 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6495 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6496 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6497 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6498 } 6499 } 6500 } 6501 6502 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6503 // It does not apply to functions. 6504 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6505 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6506 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6507 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6508 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6509 } 6510 } 6511 6512 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6513 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6514 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6515 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6516 if (VD) { 6517 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6518 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6519 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6520 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6521 } 6522 } 6523 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6524 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6525 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6526 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6527 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6528 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6529 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6530 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6531 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6532 << &ND << Attr; 6533 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6534 } 6535 } 6536 6537 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6538 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6539 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6540 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6541 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6542 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6543 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6544 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6545 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6546 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6547 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6548 // by applying it to the function type. 6549 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6550 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6551 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6552 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6553 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6554 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6555 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6556 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6557 } 6558 } 6559 } 6560 } 6561 } 6562 6563 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6564 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6565 bool IsSpecialization, 6566 bool IsDefinition) { 6567 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6568 return; 6569 6570 bool IsTemplate = false; 6571 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6572 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6573 IsTemplate = true; 6574 if (!IsSpecialization) 6575 IsDefinition = false; 6576 } 6577 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6578 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6579 IsTemplate = true; 6580 } 6581 6582 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6583 return; 6584 6585 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6586 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6587 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6588 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6589 6590 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6591 // inherited attribute instances. 6592 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6593 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6594 6595 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6596 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6597 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6598 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6599 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6600 6601 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6602 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6603 bool JustWarn = false; 6604 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6605 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6606 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6607 JustWarn = true; 6608 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6609 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6610 JustWarn = true; 6611 } 6612 6613 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6614 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6615 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6616 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6617 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6618 JustWarn = false; 6619 6620 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6621 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6622 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6623 << NewDecl 6624 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6625 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6626 if (!JustWarn) { 6627 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6628 return; 6629 } 6630 } 6631 6632 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6633 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6634 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6635 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6636 // it were marked dllexport. 6637 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6638 bool IsMicrosoftABI = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols(); 6639 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6640 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 6641 // separately. 6642 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 6643 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 6644 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 6645 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6646 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 6647 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 6648 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 6649 } 6650 6651 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 6652 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 6653 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 6654 if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) { 6655 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6656 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 6657 << NewDecl; 6658 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6659 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6660 NewDecl->addAttr( 6661 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 6662 } else { 6663 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6664 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 6665 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6666 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6667 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 6668 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6669 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6670 } 6671 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) { 6672 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 6673 // attribute. 6674 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6675 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6676 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6677 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 6678 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6679 } 6680 6681 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 6682 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 6683 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 6684 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 6685 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6686 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 6687 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 6688 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 6689 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 6690 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 6691 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 6692 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 6693 } 6694 } 6695 } 6696 } 6697 6698 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 6699 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 6700 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 6701 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 6702 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 6703 6704 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 6705 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 6706 6707 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 6708 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 6709 return false; 6710 6711 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 6712 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 6713 } 6714 6715 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 6716 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 6717 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 6718 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 6719 /// 6720 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 6721 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 6722 /// 6723 /// For instance: 6724 /// 6725 /// auto x = []{}; 6726 /// 6727 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 6728 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 6729 /// 6730 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 6731 template<typename T> 6732 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 6733 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6734 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 6735 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 6736 return false; 6737 6738 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 6739 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 6740 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 6741 return false; 6742 } 6743 return D->isExternC(); 6744 } 6745 6746 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 6747 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6748 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 6749 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6750 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 6751 if (DC->isFileContext()) 6752 return true; 6753 if (DC->isRecord()) 6754 return false; 6755 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 6756 return false; 6757 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6758 } 6759 6760 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 6761 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6762 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 6763 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6764 return true; 6765 if (DC->isRecord()) 6766 return false; 6767 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6768 } 6769 6770 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 6771 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 6772 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 6773 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6774 return true; 6775 6776 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 6777 // position to the decl itself. 6778 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 6779 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6780 return true; 6781 } 6782 6783 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 6784 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 6785 } 6786 6787 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 6788 /// function-local external declaration. 6789 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 6790 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6791 return false; 6792 6793 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 6794 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 6795 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 6796 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 6797 return true; 6798 6799 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 6800 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 6801 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 6802 // innermost enclosing namespace. 6803 // 6804 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 6805 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 6806 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 6807 DC = DC->getParent(); 6808 return true; 6809 } 6810 6811 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 6812 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 6813 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 6814 return FD->isExternC(); 6815 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 6816 return VD->isExternC(); 6817 6818 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 6819 } 6820 6821 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 6822 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) { 6823 DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext(); 6824 QualType R = NewVD->getType(); 6825 6826 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 6827 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 6828 // argument. 6829 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 6830 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 6831 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 6832 << R; 6833 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6834 return false; 6835 } 6836 6837 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 6838 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 6839 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 6840 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 6841 // scope. 6842 if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 6843 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 6844 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), 6845 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 6846 << R; 6847 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6848 return false; 6849 } 6850 } 6851 6852 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 6853 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", 6854 Se.getLangOpts())) { 6855 QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType(); 6856 while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 6857 NR->isReferenceType()) { 6858 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() || 6859 NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) { 6860 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) 6861 << NR->isReferenceType(); 6862 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6863 return false; 6864 } 6865 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 6866 } 6867 } 6868 6869 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", 6870 Se.getLangOpts())) { 6871 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 6872 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 6873 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 6874 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 6875 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6876 return false; 6877 } 6878 } 6879 6880 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 6881 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 6882 // address space qualifiers. 6883 if (R->isEventT()) { 6884 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 6885 Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 6886 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6887 return false; 6888 } 6889 } 6890 6891 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 6892 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 6893 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 6894 // space qualifiers. 6895 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 6896 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 6897 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 6898 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6899 } 6900 6901 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 6902 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 6903 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 6904 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 6905 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 6906 R.isConstQualified())) { 6907 Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 6908 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6909 } 6910 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 6911 return false; 6912 } 6913 6914 return true; 6915 } 6916 6917 template <typename AttrTy> 6918 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) { 6919 const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl(); 6920 if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) { 6921 AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context); 6922 Clone->setInherited(true); 6923 D->addAttr(Clone); 6924 } 6925 } 6926 6927 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 6928 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6929 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 6930 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 6931 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6932 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 6933 6934 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 6935 6936 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6937 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 6938 // purposes. 6939 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 6940 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 6941 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 6942 Name = II; 6943 } 6944 } else if (!II) { 6945 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 6946 return nullptr; 6947 } 6948 6949 6950 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 6951 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 6952 6953 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 6954 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 6955 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 6956 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 6957 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 6958 SC = SC_Extern; 6959 6960 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 6961 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 6962 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 6963 6964 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 6965 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 6966 // an error here 6967 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 6968 D.setInvalidType(); 6969 SC = SC_None; 6970 } 6971 6972 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 6973 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 6974 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 6975 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 6976 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 6977 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 6978 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6979 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 6980 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 6981 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 6982 } 6983 6984 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6985 6986 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6987 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 6988 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 6989 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 6990 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 6991 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 6992 D.setInvalidType(); 6993 } 6994 } 6995 6996 // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to 6997 // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid. 6998 if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType()) 6999 tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7000 /*DiagID=*/0); 7001 7002 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 7003 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 7004 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 7005 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 7006 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 7007 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 7008 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 7009 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7010 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7011 II, R, TInfo, SC); 7012 7013 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7014 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7015 7016 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7017 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7018 7019 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 7020 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7021 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 7022 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 7023 } else { 7024 bool Invalid = false; 7025 7026 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7027 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 7028 switch (SC) { 7029 case SC_None: 7030 break; 7031 case SC_Static: 7032 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7033 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7034 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7035 break; 7036 case SC_Auto: 7037 case SC_Register: 7038 case SC_Extern: 7039 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 7040 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 7041 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 7042 // of class members 7043 7044 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7045 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 7046 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7047 break; 7048 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7049 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 7050 } 7051 } 7052 7053 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 7054 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 7055 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 7056 // incompatible with static data members. 7057 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 7058 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 7059 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 7060 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7061 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 7062 break; 7063 } 7064 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 7065 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 7066 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 7067 break; 7068 } 7069 } 7070 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 7071 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 7072 // members. 7073 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7074 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 7075 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 7076 } else if (AnonStruct) { 7077 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 7078 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 7079 // static data members. 7080 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7081 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 7082 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 7083 Invalid = true; 7084 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 7085 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 7086 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 7087 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7088 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 7089 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 7090 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 7091 } 7092 } 7093 } 7094 7095 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7096 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7097 bool InvalidScope = false; 7098 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7099 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7100 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7101 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 7102 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7103 : nullptr, 7104 TemplateParamLists, 7105 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 7106 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 7107 7108 if (TemplateParams) { 7109 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 7110 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7111 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 7112 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 7113 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7114 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 7115 << II 7116 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 7117 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 7118 TemplateParams = nullptr; 7119 } else { 7120 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7121 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7122 return nullptr; 7123 7124 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 7125 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 7126 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 7127 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 7128 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 7129 // This is a template declaration. 7130 IsVariableTemplate = true; 7131 7132 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 7133 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7134 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 7135 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7136 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7137 } 7138 } 7139 } else { 7140 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7141 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7142 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7143 return nullptr; 7144 assert((Invalid || 7145 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7146 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7147 } 7148 7149 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7150 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7151 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7152 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7153 : SourceLocation(); 7154 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7155 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7156 IsPartialSpecialization); 7157 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7158 return nullptr; 7159 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7160 AddToScope = false; 7161 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7162 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7163 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7164 Bindings); 7165 } else 7166 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7167 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7168 7169 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7170 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7171 NewTemplate = 7172 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7173 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7174 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7175 } 7176 7177 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7178 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7179 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7180 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7181 7182 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7183 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7184 if (NewTemplate) 7185 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7186 } 7187 7188 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7189 7190 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7191 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7192 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7193 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7194 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7195 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7196 } 7197 7198 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7199 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7200 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7201 << 0; 7202 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7203 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7204 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7205 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7206 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7207 } else { 7208 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7209 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7210 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7211 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7212 } 7213 } 7214 7215 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7216 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7217 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7218 if (NewTemplate) 7219 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7220 7221 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7222 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7223 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7224 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7225 else 7226 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7227 } 7228 7229 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7230 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7231 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7232 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7233 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7234 // explicitly. 7235 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7236 // 'extern'. 7237 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7238 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7239 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7240 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7241 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7242 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7243 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7244 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7245 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7246 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7247 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7248 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7249 // error should be ignored. 7250 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7251 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7252 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7253 // to emit any code for it. 7254 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7255 } else 7256 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7257 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7258 } else 7259 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7260 } 7261 7262 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7263 case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified: 7264 break; 7265 7266 case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval: 7267 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7268 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7269 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 7270 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7271 7272 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr: 7273 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7274 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7275 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7276 // implicitly an inline variable. 7277 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7278 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7279 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7280 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7281 break; 7282 7283 case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit: 7284 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7285 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7286 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7287 else 7288 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7289 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7290 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7291 break; 7292 } 7293 7294 // C99 6.7.4p3 7295 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7296 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7297 // thread storage duration... 7298 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7299 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7300 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7301 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7302 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7303 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7304 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7305 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7306 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7307 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7308 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7309 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7310 } 7311 } 7312 7313 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7314 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7315 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7316 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7317 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7318 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7319 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7320 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7321 << 2 7322 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7323 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7324 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7325 << 0 << NewVD 7326 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7327 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7328 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7329 else { 7330 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7331 if (NewTemplate) 7332 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7333 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7334 B->setModulePrivate(); 7335 } 7336 } 7337 7338 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7339 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7340 7341 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 7342 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 7343 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7344 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 7345 << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString() 7346 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 7347 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7348 } 7349 } 7350 7351 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7352 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7353 7354 // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should 7355 // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function 7356 // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally 7357 // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen. 7358 if (R->isFunctionPointerType()) 7359 if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>()) 7360 copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT); 7361 7362 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7363 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7364 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7365 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7366 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7367 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7368 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7369 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7370 7371 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7372 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7373 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7374 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7375 // storage [duration]." 7376 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7377 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7378 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7379 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7380 } 7381 } 7382 7383 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7384 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7385 // check the VarDecl itself. 7386 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7387 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7388 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7389 7390 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7391 // retainable type. 7392 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7393 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7394 7395 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7396 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7397 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7398 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7399 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7400 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7401 switch (SC) { 7402 case SC_None: 7403 case SC_Auto: 7404 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7405 break; 7406 case SC_Register: 7407 // Local Named register 7408 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7409 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7410 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7411 break; 7412 case SC_Static: 7413 case SC_Extern: 7414 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7415 break; 7416 } 7417 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7418 // Global Named register 7419 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7420 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7421 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7422 7423 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7424 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7425 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7426 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7427 HasSizeMismatch)) 7428 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7429 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7430 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7431 } 7432 7433 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7434 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7435 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7436 } 7437 } 7438 7439 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7440 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7441 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7442 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7443 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7444 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7445 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7446 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7447 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7448 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7449 } else 7450 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7451 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7452 } 7453 } 7454 7455 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7456 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7457 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7458 : nullptr; 7459 7460 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7461 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7462 // declaration has linkage). 7463 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7464 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7465 IsMemberSpecialization || 7466 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7467 7468 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7469 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7470 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7471 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7472 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7473 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7474 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7475 7476 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7477 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7478 } else { 7479 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7480 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7481 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7482 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7483 7484 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7485 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7486 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7487 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7488 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7489 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7490 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7491 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7492 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7493 Previous.clear(); 7494 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7495 } 7496 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7497 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7498 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7499 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7500 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7501 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7502 } 7503 7504 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7505 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7506 7507 if (NewTemplate) { 7508 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7509 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7510 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7511 : nullptr; 7512 7513 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7514 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7515 // template declaration. 7516 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7517 TemplateParams, 7518 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7519 : nullptr, 7520 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7521 DC->isDependentContext()) 7522 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7523 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7524 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7525 7526 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7527 // template, make a note of that. 7528 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7529 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7530 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7531 } 7532 } 7533 7534 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7535 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7536 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7537 7538 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7539 7540 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7541 // the map of such variables. 7542 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7543 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7544 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7545 7546 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7547 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7548 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7549 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7550 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7551 if (MCtx) { 7552 Context.setManglingNumber( 7553 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7554 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7555 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7556 } 7557 } 7558 7559 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7560 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7561 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7562 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7563 7564 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7565 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7566 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7567 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7568 7569 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7570 // behavior. 7571 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7572 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7573 } 7574 7575 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7576 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7577 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7578 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7579 } 7580 7581 if (NewTemplate) { 7582 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7583 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7584 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7585 return NewTemplate; 7586 } 7587 7588 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7589 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7590 7591 return NewVD; 7592 } 7593 7594 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7595 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7596 SDK_Local, 7597 SDK_Global, 7598 SDK_StaticMember, 7599 SDK_Field, 7600 SDK_Typedef, 7601 SDK_Using, 7602 SDK_StructuredBinding 7603 }; 7604 7605 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7606 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7607 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7608 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7609 return SDK_Using; 7610 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7611 return SDK_Typedef; 7612 else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7613 return SDK_StructuredBinding; 7614 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7615 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7616 7617 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7618 } 7619 7620 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7621 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7622 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7623 const VarDecl *VD) { 7624 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7625 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7626 return Capture.getLocation(); 7627 } 7628 return SourceLocation(); 7629 } 7630 7631 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7632 const LookupResult &R) { 7633 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7634 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7635 return false; 7636 7637 // Return false if warning is ignored. 7638 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 7639 } 7640 7641 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7642 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7643 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 7644 const LookupResult &R) { 7645 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7646 return nullptr; 7647 7648 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 7649 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 7650 return nullptr; 7651 7652 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7653 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7654 : nullptr; 7655 } 7656 7657 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 7658 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7659 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 7660 const LookupResult &R) { 7661 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 7662 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 7663 return nullptr; 7664 7665 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7666 return nullptr; 7667 7668 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7669 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 7670 } 7671 7672 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7673 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7674 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D, 7675 const LookupResult &R) { 7676 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7677 return nullptr; 7678 7679 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7680 return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl 7681 : nullptr; 7682 } 7683 7684 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 7685 /// -Wshadow. 7686 /// 7687 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 7688 /// scope. 7689 /// 7690 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 7691 /// \param R the lookup of the name 7692 /// 7693 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7694 const LookupResult &R) { 7695 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 7696 7697 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 7698 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 7699 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 7700 if (MD->isStatic()) 7701 return; 7702 7703 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 7704 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 7705 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 7706 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 7707 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 7708 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 7709 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 7710 return; 7711 } 7712 } 7713 7714 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7715 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 7716 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 7717 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 7718 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 7719 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 7720 ShadowedDecl = I; 7721 break; 7722 } 7723 } 7724 7725 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7726 7727 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 7728 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 7729 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 7730 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 7731 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 7732 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 7733 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 7734 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 7735 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 7736 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 7737 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 7738 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7739 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 7740 } else { 7741 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 7742 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 7743 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 7744 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 7745 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 7746 return; 7747 } 7748 } 7749 7750 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 7751 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 7752 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 7753 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 7754 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 7755 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 7756 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 7757 // can capture; other scopes don't. 7758 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 7759 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 7760 return; 7761 } 7762 } 7763 } 7764 } 7765 } 7766 7767 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 7768 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 7769 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 7770 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 7771 return; 7772 7773 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 7774 // static data members from base classes? 7775 7776 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 7777 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 7778 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 7779 } 7780 7781 7782 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 7783 7784 // Emit warning and note. 7785 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(R.getNameLoc())) 7786 return; 7787 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 7788 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 7789 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7790 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 7791 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 7792 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7793 } 7794 7795 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 7796 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 7797 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 7798 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 7799 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 7800 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 7801 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 7802 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 7803 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 7804 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 7805 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 7806 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 7807 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 7808 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7809 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 7810 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 7811 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7812 } 7813 } 7814 7815 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 7816 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 7817 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 7818 return; 7819 7820 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 7821 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 7822 LookupName(R, S); 7823 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 7824 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 7825 } 7826 7827 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 7828 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 7829 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 7830 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 7831 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 7832 return; 7833 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7834 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 7835 if (!DRE) 7836 return; 7837 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 7838 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 7839 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 7840 return; 7841 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 7842 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 7843 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 7844 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 7845 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7846 7847 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 7848 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 7849 } 7850 7851 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 7852 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 7853 template<typename T> 7854 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 7855 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 7856 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 7857 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 7858 7859 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 7860 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 7861 // declaration. 7862 return false; 7863 } 7864 7865 if (Prev) { 7866 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 7867 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 7868 // redeclaration. 7869 Previous.clear(); 7870 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 7871 return true; 7872 } 7873 7874 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 7875 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 7876 // declaration. 7877 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 7878 return false; 7879 } else { 7880 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 7881 // translation unit which might conflict. 7882 if (IsGlobal) { 7883 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 7884 IsGlobal = false; 7885 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 7886 I != E; ++I) { 7887 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 7888 Prev = *I; 7889 break; 7890 } 7891 } 7892 } else { 7893 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 7894 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 7895 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 7896 I != E; ++I) { 7897 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 7898 Prev = *I; 7899 break; 7900 } 7901 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 7902 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 7903 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 7904 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 7905 // diagnostic. 7906 } 7907 } 7908 7909 if (!Prev) 7910 return false; 7911 } 7912 7913 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 7914 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 7915 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 7916 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 7917 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 7918 else 7919 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 7920 7921 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 7922 << IsGlobal << ND; 7923 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 7924 << IsGlobal; 7925 return false; 7926 } 7927 7928 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 7929 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 7930 /// 7931 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 7932 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 7933 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 7934 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 7935 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 7936 template<typename T> 7937 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 7938 LookupResult &Previous) { 7939 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7940 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 7941 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 7942 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 7943 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 7944 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 7945 Previous.clear(); 7946 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 7947 return true; 7948 } 7949 } 7950 return false; 7951 } 7952 7953 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 7954 // declaration. 7955 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 7956 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 7957 7958 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 7959 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 7960 // in another scope. 7961 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 7962 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 7963 7964 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 7965 return false; 7966 } 7967 7968 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 7969 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 7970 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7971 return; 7972 7973 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 7974 7975 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 7976 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 7977 return; 7978 7979 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 7980 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 7981 7982 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 7983 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 7984 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 7985 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 7986 NewVD->setType(T); 7987 } 7988 7989 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 7990 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 7991 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 7992 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 7993 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7994 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 7995 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 7996 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7997 return; 7998 } 7999 8000 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 8001 // scope. 8002 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 8003 !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers", 8004 getLangOpts()) && 8005 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 8006 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 8007 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8008 return; 8009 } 8010 8011 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8012 if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD)) 8013 return; 8014 8015 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 8016 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8017 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 8018 return; 8019 } 8020 8021 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 8022 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 8023 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 8024 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 8025 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 8026 << 0 /*const*/; 8027 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8028 return; 8029 } 8030 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8031 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 8032 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8033 return; 8034 } 8035 } 8036 8037 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 8038 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 8039 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 8040 if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() && 8041 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8042 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 8043 getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported( 8044 getLangOpts())))) { 8045 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 8046 if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts())) 8047 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8048 << Scope << "global or constant"; 8049 else 8050 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 8051 << Scope << "constant"; 8052 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8053 return; 8054 } 8055 } else { 8056 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 8057 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8058 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 8059 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8060 return; 8061 } 8062 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 8063 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 8064 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 8065 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 8066 // in functions. 8067 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8068 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8069 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8070 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 8071 else 8072 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 8073 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 8074 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8075 return; 8076 } 8077 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 8078 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 8079 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 8080 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 8081 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 8082 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8083 << "constant"; 8084 else 8085 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 8086 << "local"; 8087 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8088 return; 8089 } 8090 } 8091 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 8092 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 8093 // space yet. 8094 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 8095 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 8096 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 8097 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8098 return; 8099 } 8100 } 8101 } 8102 8103 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 8104 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8105 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 8106 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 8107 else { 8108 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 8109 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 8110 } 8111 } 8112 8113 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 8114 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 8115 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8116 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 8117 8118 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 8119 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 8120 bool SizeIsNegative; 8121 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 8122 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 8123 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 8124 QualType FixedT; 8125 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 8126 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 8127 else if (FixedTInfo) { 8128 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 8129 // both types separately. 8130 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 8131 Oversized); 8132 } 8133 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 8134 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 8135 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 8136 // int a[10][n]; 8137 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 8138 8139 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8140 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 8141 << SizeRange; 8142 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 8143 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 8144 << SizeRange; 8145 else 8146 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 8147 << SizeRange; 8148 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8149 return; 8150 } 8151 8152 if (!FixedTInfo) { 8153 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 8154 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 8155 else 8156 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 8157 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8158 return; 8159 } 8160 8161 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8162 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8163 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8164 } 8165 8166 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8167 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8168 // of objects and functions. 8169 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8170 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8171 << T; 8172 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8173 return; 8174 } 8175 } 8176 8177 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8178 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8179 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8180 return; 8181 } 8182 8183 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8184 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8185 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8186 return; 8187 } 8188 8189 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8190 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8191 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8192 return; 8193 } 8194 8195 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8196 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8197 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8198 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8199 return; 8200 } 8201 8202 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8203 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8204 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8205 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8206 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8207 return; 8208 } 8209 } 8210 8211 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8212 /// declaration. 8213 /// 8214 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8215 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8216 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8217 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8218 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8219 /// 8220 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8221 /// 8222 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8223 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8224 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8225 8226 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8227 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8228 return false; 8229 8230 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8231 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8232 if (Previous.empty() && 8233 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8234 Previous.setShadowed(); 8235 8236 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8237 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8238 return true; 8239 } 8240 return false; 8241 } 8242 8243 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8244 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8245 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8246 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden; 8247 8248 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8249 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false, 8250 /*DetectVirtual=*/false); 8251 auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8252 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 8253 DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName(); 8254 8255 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8256 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8257 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8258 CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8259 Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8260 } 8261 8262 for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) { 8263 CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD = 8264 dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl()); 8265 if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() || 8266 IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8267 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8268 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires 8269 // clauses when overriding. 8270 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8271 continue; 8272 8273 if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) { 8274 MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD); 8275 CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD); 8276 CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD); 8277 CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD); 8278 CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD); 8279 } 8280 8281 // A method can only override one function from each base class. We 8282 // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases. 8283 return true; 8284 } 8285 8286 return false; 8287 }; 8288 8289 DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths); 8290 return !Overridden.empty(); 8291 } 8292 8293 namespace { 8294 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8295 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8296 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8297 Scope *S; 8298 Declarator &D; 8299 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8300 bool AddToScope; 8301 }; 8302 } // end anonymous namespace 8303 8304 namespace { 8305 8306 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8307 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8308 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8309 public: 8310 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8311 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8312 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8313 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8314 8315 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8316 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8317 return false; 8318 8319 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8320 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8321 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8322 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8323 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8324 8325 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8326 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8327 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8328 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8329 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8330 return true; 8331 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8332 return true; 8333 } 8334 } 8335 } 8336 8337 return false; 8338 } 8339 8340 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8341 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8342 } 8343 8344 private: 8345 ASTContext &Context; 8346 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8347 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8348 }; 8349 8350 } // end anonymous namespace 8351 8352 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8353 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8354 } 8355 8356 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8357 /// 8358 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8359 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8360 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8361 /// the same name. 8362 /// 8363 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8364 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8365 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8366 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8367 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8368 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8369 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8370 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8371 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8372 TypoCorrection Correction; 8373 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8374 unsigned DiagMsg = 8375 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8376 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8377 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8378 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8379 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8380 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8381 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8382 8383 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8384 if (IsLocalFriend) 8385 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8386 else 8387 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8388 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8389 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8390 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8391 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8392 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8393 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8394 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8395 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8396 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8397 if (FD && 8398 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8399 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8400 // involve a parameter 8401 unsigned ParamNum = 8402 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8403 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8404 } 8405 } 8406 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8407 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8408 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8409 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8410 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8411 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8412 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8413 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8414 Previous.clear(); 8415 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8416 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8417 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8418 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8419 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8420 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8421 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8422 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8423 } 8424 } 8425 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8426 8427 NamedDecl *Result; 8428 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8429 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8430 { 8431 // Trap errors. 8432 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8433 8434 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8435 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8436 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8437 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8438 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8439 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8440 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8441 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8442 8443 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8444 Result = nullptr; 8445 } 8446 8447 if (Result) { 8448 // Determine which correction we picked. 8449 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8450 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8451 I != E; ++I) 8452 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8453 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8454 8455 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8456 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8457 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8458 Correction, 8459 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8460 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8461 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8462 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8463 return Result; 8464 } 8465 8466 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8467 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8468 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8469 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8470 Previous.clear(); 8471 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8472 } 8473 8474 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8475 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8476 8477 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8478 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8479 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8480 8481 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8482 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8483 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8484 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8485 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8486 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8487 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8488 8489 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8490 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8491 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8492 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8493 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8494 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8495 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8496 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8497 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8498 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8499 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8500 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd(); 8501 } else 8502 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8503 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8504 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8505 } 8506 return nullptr; 8507 } 8508 8509 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8510 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8511 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8512 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8513 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8514 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8515 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8516 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8517 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8518 D.setInvalidType(); 8519 break; 8520 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8521 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8522 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8523 return SC_None; 8524 return SC_Extern; 8525 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8526 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8527 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8528 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8529 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8530 // other than extern 8531 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8532 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8533 diag::err_static_block_func); 8534 break; 8535 } else 8536 return SC_Static; 8537 } 8538 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8539 } 8540 8541 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8542 return SC_None; 8543 } 8544 8545 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8546 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8547 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8548 StorageClass SC, 8549 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8550 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8551 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8552 8553 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8554 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8555 8556 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8557 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8558 // prototype. This true when: 8559 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8560 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8561 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8562 // function type). 8563 bool HasPrototype = 8564 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8565 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8566 8567 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 8568 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8569 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype, 8570 ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified, 8571 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8572 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8573 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8574 8575 return NewFD; 8576 } 8577 8578 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8579 8580 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8581 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) { 8582 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8583 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8584 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 8585 ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified; 8586 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8587 } 8588 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8589 8590 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8591 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8592 // the class has been completely parsed. 8593 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8594 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8595 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8596 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8597 D.setInvalidType(); 8598 8599 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8600 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8601 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8602 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8603 8604 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8605 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8606 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8607 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), 8608 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8609 InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8610 8611 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8612 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8613 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8614 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8615 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8616 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8617 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8618 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8619 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8620 TrailingRequiresClause); 8621 8622 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 8623 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 8624 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 8625 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 8626 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 8627 8628 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8629 return NewDD; 8630 8631 } else { 8632 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 8633 D.setInvalidType(); 8634 8635 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 8636 // code path. 8637 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8638 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, 8639 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8640 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8641 } 8642 8643 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 8644 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 8645 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8646 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 8647 return nullptr; 8648 } 8649 8650 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8651 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8652 return nullptr; 8653 8654 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8655 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 8656 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8657 TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8658 ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8659 TrailingRequiresClause); 8660 8661 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 8662 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 8663 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 8664 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 8665 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 8666 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8667 8668 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8669 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8670 D.getEndLoc()); 8671 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 8672 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 8673 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 8674 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 8675 // constructor if it has no return type). 8676 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 8677 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 8678 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 8679 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 8680 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8681 return nullptr; 8682 } 8683 8684 // This is a C++ method declaration. 8685 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 8686 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8687 TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8688 ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause); 8689 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 8690 return Ret; 8691 } else { 8692 bool isFriend = 8693 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8694 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 8695 return nullptr; 8696 8697 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8698 // prototype. This true when: 8699 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 8700 return FunctionDecl::Create( 8701 SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, 8702 SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, 8703 true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8704 } 8705 } 8706 8707 enum OpenCLParamType { 8708 ValidKernelParam, 8709 PtrPtrKernelParam, 8710 PtrKernelParam, 8711 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 8712 InvalidKernelParam, 8713 RecordKernelParam 8714 }; 8715 8716 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 8717 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 8718 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 8719 // integers other than by their names. 8720 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 8721 8722 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 8723 // for a size dependent type. 8724 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 8725 do { 8726 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 8727 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 8728 if (Names.end() != Match) 8729 return true; 8730 8731 Ty = DesugaredTy; 8732 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 8733 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 8734 8735 return false; 8736 } 8737 8738 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 8739 if (PT->isDependentType()) 8740 return InvalidKernelParam; 8741 8742 if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) { 8743 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 8744 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 8745 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 8746 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 8747 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 8748 8749 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) { 8750 // This is a pointer to pointer parameter. 8751 // Recursively check inner type. 8752 OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType); 8753 if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam || 8754 ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam) 8755 return ParamKind; 8756 8757 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 8758 } 8759 8760 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 8761 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 8762 // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to 8763 // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters. 8764 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 8765 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 8766 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 8767 !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() && 8768 !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType()) 8769 return InvalidKernelParam; 8770 8771 return PtrKernelParam; 8772 } 8773 8774 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 8775 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 8776 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 8777 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 8778 // of these built-in scalar types. 8779 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 8780 return InvalidKernelParam; 8781 8782 if (PT->isImageType()) 8783 return PtrKernelParam; 8784 8785 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 8786 return InvalidKernelParam; 8787 8788 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 8789 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 8790 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 8791 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) && 8792 PT->isHalfType()) 8793 return InvalidKernelParam; 8794 8795 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 8796 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 8797 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 8798 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 8799 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 8800 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 8801 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 8802 } 8803 8804 // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4: 8805 // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be: 8806 // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data 8807 // types) for parameters passed by value; 8808 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && 8809 !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 8810 "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) && 8811 !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context)) 8812 return InvalidKernelParam; 8813 8814 if (PT->isRecordType()) 8815 return RecordKernelParam; 8816 8817 return ValidKernelParam; 8818 } 8819 8820 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 8821 Sema &S, 8822 Declarator &D, 8823 ParmVarDecl *Param, 8824 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 8825 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 8826 8827 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 8828 // used again 8829 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 8830 return; 8831 8832 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 8833 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 8834 // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a: 8835 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer 8836 // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below. 8837 if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) { 8838 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 8839 D.setInvalidType(); 8840 return; 8841 } 8842 8843 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 8844 return; 8845 8846 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 8847 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 8848 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 8849 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 8850 // __constant. 8851 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 8852 D.setInvalidType(); 8853 return; 8854 8855 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 8856 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 8857 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 8858 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 8859 // one of these built-in scalar types. 8860 8861 case InvalidKernelParam: 8862 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 8863 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 8864 // of event_t type. 8865 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 8866 // type for any function elsewhere. 8867 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 8868 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 8869 8870 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 8871 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 8872 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 8873 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 8874 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 8875 if (Loc.isValid()) 8876 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 8877 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 8878 } 8879 } 8880 8881 D.setInvalidType(); 8882 return; 8883 8884 case PtrKernelParam: 8885 case ValidKernelParam: 8886 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 8887 return; 8888 8889 case RecordKernelParam: 8890 break; 8891 } 8892 8893 // Track nested structs we will inspect 8894 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 8895 8896 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 8897 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 8898 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 8899 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 8900 8901 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 8902 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 8903 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 8904 const RecordType *RecTy = 8905 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8906 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 8907 8908 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 8909 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 8910 8911 do { 8912 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 8913 if (!Next) { 8914 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 8915 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 8916 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 8917 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 8918 8919 continue; 8920 } 8921 8922 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 8923 // field itself) to the history stack. 8924 const RecordDecl *RD; 8925 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 8926 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 8927 8928 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 8929 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 8930 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 8931 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 8932 "Unexpected type."); 8933 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 8934 8935 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 8936 } else { 8937 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 8938 } 8939 8940 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 8941 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 8942 8943 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 8944 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 8945 8946 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 8947 continue; 8948 8949 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 8950 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 8951 continue; 8952 8953 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 8954 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 8955 continue; 8956 } 8957 8958 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 8959 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 8960 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 8961 // union. 8962 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 8963 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 8964 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 8965 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 8966 << PT->isUnionType() 8967 << PT; 8968 } else { 8969 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 8970 } 8971 8972 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 8973 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 8974 8975 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 8976 // the offending field came from 8977 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 8978 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 8979 E = HistoryStack.end(); 8980 I != E; ++I) { 8981 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 8982 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 8983 << OuterField->getType(); 8984 } 8985 8986 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 8987 << QT->isPointerType() 8988 << QT; 8989 D.setInvalidType(); 8990 return; 8991 } 8992 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 8993 } 8994 8995 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 8996 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 8997 /// nothing. 8998 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 8999 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 9000 DC = DC->getParent(); 9001 return DC; 9002 } 9003 9004 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 9005 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 9006 /// nothing. 9007 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 9008 while (S->isClassScope() || 9009 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 9010 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 9011 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 9012 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 9013 S = S->getParent(); 9014 return S; 9015 } 9016 9017 NamedDecl* 9018 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 9019 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 9020 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 9021 bool &AddToScope) { 9022 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 9023 9024 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 9025 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 9026 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 9027 9028 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 9029 for (TemplateParameterList *TPL : TemplateParamListsRef) 9030 TemplateParamLists.push_back(TPL); 9031 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 9032 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 9033 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 9034 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 9035 else 9036 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 9037 } 9038 9039 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 9040 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 9041 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 9042 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 9043 9044 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 9045 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9046 diag::err_invalid_thread) 9047 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 9048 9049 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 9050 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 9051 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9052 9053 bool isFriend = false; 9054 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 9055 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 9056 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9057 9058 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 9059 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9060 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 9061 9062 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 9063 9064 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 9065 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 9066 9067 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 9068 isVirtualOkay); 9069 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 9070 9071 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 9072 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 9073 9074 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 9075 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 9076 // context will be different from the semantic context. 9077 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9078 9079 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 9080 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 9081 9082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9083 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 9084 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 9085 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 9086 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 9087 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9088 // C++ [class.friend]p5 9089 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 9090 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 9091 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9092 } 9093 9094 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 9095 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 9096 // return true). 9097 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 9098 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 9099 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 9100 NewFD->setPure(true); 9101 9102 // C++ [class.union]p2 9103 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 9104 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) 9105 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 9106 } 9107 9108 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 9109 isMemberSpecialization = false; 9110 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 9111 if (D.isInvalidType()) 9112 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9113 9114 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 9115 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 9116 bool Invalid = false; 9117 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 9118 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 9119 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 9120 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 9121 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 9122 ? D.getName().TemplateId 9123 : nullptr, 9124 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 9125 Invalid); 9126 if (TemplateParams) { 9127 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9128 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 9129 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9130 9131 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 9132 // This is a function template 9133 9134 // A destructor cannot be a template. 9135 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 9136 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 9137 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9138 } 9139 9140 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 9141 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 9142 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 9143 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 9144 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 9145 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 9146 Invalid = true; 9147 } 9148 9149 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 9150 NewFD->getLocation(), 9151 Name, TemplateParams, 9152 NewFD); 9153 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 9154 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 9155 9156 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 9157 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 9158 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 9159 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 9160 .drop_back(1)); 9161 } 9162 } else { 9163 // This is a function template specialization. 9164 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9165 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9166 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9167 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9168 9169 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 9170 if (isFriend) { 9171 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 9172 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 9173 9174 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 9175 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 9176 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 9177 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 9178 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 9179 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 9180 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9181 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 9182 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 9183 } 9184 9185 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9186 << Name << RemoveRange 9187 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9188 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9189 } 9190 } 9191 } else { 9192 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9193 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9194 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9195 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9196 9197 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9198 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9199 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9200 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9201 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9202 } 9203 9204 if (Invalid) { 9205 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9206 if (FunctionTemplate) 9207 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9208 } 9209 9210 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9211 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9212 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9213 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9214 // 9215 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9216 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9217 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9218 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9219 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9220 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9221 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9222 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9223 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9224 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9225 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9226 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9227 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9228 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9229 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9230 } else { 9231 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9232 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9233 } 9234 9235 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9236 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9237 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9238 } 9239 9240 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9241 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9242 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9243 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9244 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9245 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9246 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9247 // thing to do. 9248 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9249 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9250 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9251 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9252 QualType Result = 9253 SubstAutoType(FPT->getReturnType(), Context.DependentTy); 9254 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9255 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9256 } 9257 9258 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9259 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9260 // declaration. 9261 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9262 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9263 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9264 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9265 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9266 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9267 } 9268 } 9269 9270 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9271 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9272 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9273 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9274 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9275 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9276 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9277 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9278 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9279 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9280 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9281 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9282 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9283 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9284 // or conversion function. 9285 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9286 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9287 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9288 } 9289 } 9290 9291 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 9292 if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) { 9293 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9294 // are implicitly inline. 9295 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9296 9297 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9298 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9299 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9300 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9301 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || 9302 ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) { 9303 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9304 << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind); 9305 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 9306 ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified 9307 : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9308 } 9309 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9310 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9311 // specifier. 9312 if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval && 9313 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9314 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9315 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9316 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9317 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9318 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9319 << NewFD; 9320 NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr); 9321 } 9322 } 9323 9324 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9325 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9326 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9327 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9328 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9329 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9330 << 0 9331 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9332 } else { 9333 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9334 if (FunctionTemplate) 9335 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9336 } 9337 } 9338 9339 if (isFriend) { 9340 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9341 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9342 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9343 } 9344 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9345 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9346 } 9347 9348 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9349 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9350 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9351 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 9352 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 9353 break; 9354 9355 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 9356 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9357 break; 9358 9359 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 9360 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9361 break; 9362 } 9363 9364 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9365 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9366 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 9367 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9368 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9369 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9370 } 9371 9372 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9373 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9374 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9375 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9376 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9377 // the class. 9378 9379 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9380 // member function definition. 9381 9382 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9383 // member function template declaration and class member template 9384 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9385 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9386 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9387 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9388 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9389 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9390 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9391 } 9392 9393 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9394 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9395 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9396 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9397 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9398 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9399 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9400 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9401 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9402 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9403 } 9404 9405 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9406 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9407 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9408 isMemberSpecialization || 9409 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9410 9411 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9412 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9413 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9414 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9415 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9416 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9417 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9418 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9419 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9420 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9421 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9422 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9423 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9424 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9425 } else 9426 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9427 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9428 } 9429 } 9430 9431 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9432 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9433 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9434 unsigned FTIIdx; 9435 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9436 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9437 9438 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9439 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9440 // single void argument. 9441 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9442 // already checks for that case. 9443 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9444 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9445 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9446 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9447 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9448 Params.push_back(Param); 9449 9450 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9451 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9452 } 9453 } 9454 9455 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9456 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9457 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9458 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9459 // the TU. 9460 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9461 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9462 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9463 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9464 9465 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9466 // instead. 9467 if (!TD) { 9468 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9469 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9470 } 9471 if (!TD) 9472 continue; 9473 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9474 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9475 continue; 9476 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9477 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9478 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9479 9480 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9481 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9482 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9483 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9484 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9485 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9486 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9487 } 9488 } 9489 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9490 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9491 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9492 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9493 // 9494 // @code 9495 // typedef void fn(int); 9496 // fn f; 9497 // @endcode 9498 9499 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9500 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9501 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9502 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9503 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9504 Params.push_back(Param); 9505 } 9506 } else { 9507 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9508 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9509 } 9510 9511 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9512 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9513 9514 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9515 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9516 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9517 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9518 9519 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9520 // because all functions have linkage. 9521 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9522 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9523 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9524 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9525 } 9526 9527 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9528 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9529 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9530 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9531 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9532 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9533 9534 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9535 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9536 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9537 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9538 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9539 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9540 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9541 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9542 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9543 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9544 NewFD)) 9545 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9546 } 9547 9548 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9549 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9550 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9551 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9552 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9553 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9554 } 9555 } 9556 9557 // Handle attributes. 9558 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9559 9560 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9561 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9562 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9563 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9564 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9565 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9566 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9567 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9568 } 9569 } 9570 9571 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice)) 9572 checkDeviceDecl(NewFD, D.getBeginLoc()); 9573 9574 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9575 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9576 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9577 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9578 9579 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9580 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9581 9582 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9583 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9584 isMemberSpecialization)); 9585 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9586 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9587 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9588 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9589 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9590 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9591 9592 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 9593 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 9594 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 9595 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 9596 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9597 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 9598 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 9599 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 9600 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 9601 int DiagID = 9602 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 9603 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 9604 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 9605 } 9606 } 9607 9608 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 9609 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 9610 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 9611 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9612 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 9613 } else { 9614 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 9615 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 9616 // 9617 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 9618 // 9619 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 9620 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 9621 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 9622 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 9623 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9624 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9625 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 9626 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 9627 9628 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 9629 // argument list into our AST format. 9630 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9631 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 9632 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 9633 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9634 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 9635 TemplateId->NumArgs); 9636 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 9637 TemplateArgs); 9638 9639 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9640 9641 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9642 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9643 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 9644 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 9645 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 9646 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9647 9648 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9649 } else { 9650 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 9651 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 9652 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 9653 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 9654 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9655 } 9656 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9657 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 9658 // wrote something like: 9659 // template <> friend void foo(int); 9660 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 9661 // friend void foo<>(int); 9662 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 9663 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9664 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9665 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9666 } 9667 9668 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 9669 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 9670 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 9671 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 9672 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 9673 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 9674 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 9675 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 9676 9677 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 9678 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 9679 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 9680 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 9681 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 9682 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 9683 TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( 9684 TemplateArgs.arguments()))) { 9685 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 9686 "friend function specialization without template args"); 9687 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 9688 Previous)) 9689 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9690 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9691 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 9692 && !isFriend) { 9693 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 9694 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9695 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9696 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 9697 Previous)) 9698 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9699 9700 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 9701 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 9702 // specialization (14.7.3) 9703 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 9704 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 9705 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 9706 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 9707 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9708 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 9709 << SC 9710 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9711 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9712 9713 else 9714 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9715 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 9716 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9717 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9718 } 9719 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 9720 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 9721 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9722 } 9723 9724 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9725 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 9726 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9727 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9728 9729 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9730 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9731 9732 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9733 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9734 isMemberSpecialization)); 9735 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9736 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9737 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9738 } 9739 9740 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9741 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9742 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9743 9744 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 9745 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 9746 : NewFD); 9747 9748 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 9749 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 9750 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9751 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 9752 9753 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 9754 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 9755 } 9756 9757 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 9758 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 9759 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 9760 9761 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 9762 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 9763 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9764 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 9765 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 9766 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 9767 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 9768 : nullptr, 9769 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 9770 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 9771 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 9772 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 9773 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 9774 DC && DC->isRecord() && 9775 DC->isDependentContext()) 9776 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 9777 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 9778 } 9779 9780 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9781 // Ignore all the rest of this. 9782 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 9783 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 9784 AddToScope }; 9785 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 9786 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 9787 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9788 9789 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 9790 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 9791 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 9792 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 9793 9794 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 9795 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 9796 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 9797 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 9798 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 9799 // can actually do this check immediately. 9800 // 9801 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 9802 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 9803 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 9804 if (isFriend && 9805 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 9806 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 9807 // ignore these 9808 } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 9809 NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) { 9810 // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new 9811 // versions of the function. 9812 } else { 9813 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 9814 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 9815 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 9816 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 9817 // 9818 // class X { 9819 // void f() const; 9820 // }; 9821 // 9822 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 9823 // 9824 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 9825 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 9826 // whether the parameter types are references). 9827 9828 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 9829 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 9830 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 9831 return Result; 9832 } 9833 } 9834 9835 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 9836 // to something. 9837 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 9838 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 9839 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 9840 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 9841 return Result; 9842 } 9843 } 9844 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9845 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 9846 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 9847 !isMemberSpecialization) { 9848 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 9849 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 9850 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 9851 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 9852 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 9853 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 9854 // generate them. 9855 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 9856 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 9857 } 9858 } 9859 9860 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 9861 // attributes as appropriate. 9862 if (!D.isRedeclaration() && 9863 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 9864 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 9865 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 9866 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 9867 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 9868 // matching regardless of its declared type. 9869 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 9870 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9871 } else { 9872 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 9873 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 9874 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 9875 9876 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 9877 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 9878 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 9879 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9880 } 9881 } else if (BuiltinID == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo && 9882 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 9883 // FIXME: We should consider this a builtin only in the std namespace. 9884 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9885 } 9886 } 9887 } 9888 } 9889 9890 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 9891 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 9892 9893 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 9894 9895 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 9896 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9897 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9898 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 9899 << NewFD; 9900 9901 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 9902 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 9903 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 9904 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 9905 EPI.Variadic = true; 9906 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 9907 9908 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 9909 NewFD->setType(R); 9910 } 9911 9912 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 9913 // member, set the visibility of this function. 9914 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 9915 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 9916 9917 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 9918 // marking the function. 9919 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 9920 9921 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply optnone due to 9922 // a pragma. 9923 if(D.isFunctionDefinition()) 9924 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 9925 9926 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 9927 // the map of such variables. 9928 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9929 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 9930 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 9931 9932 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 9933 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 9934 9935 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 9936 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 9937 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 9938 isMemberSpecialization || 9939 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 9940 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 9941 } 9942 9943 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9944 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 9945 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 9946 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9947 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 9948 if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 9949 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 9950 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 9951 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 9952 } 9953 9954 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 9955 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 9956 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 9957 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 9958 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 9959 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 9960 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 9961 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9962 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 9963 } 9964 } 9965 9966 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 9967 9968 9969 9970 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 9971 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 9972 if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) 9973 && (SC == SC_Static)) { 9974 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 9975 D.setInvalidType(); 9976 } 9977 9978 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 9979 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 9980 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 9981 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 9982 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 9983 : FixItHint()); 9984 D.setInvalidType(); 9985 } 9986 9987 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 9988 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 9989 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 9990 9991 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 9992 if (DC->isRecord()) { 9993 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 9994 D.setInvalidType(); 9995 } 9996 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9997 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 9998 D.setInvalidType(); 9999 } 10000 } 10001 } 10002 10003 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10004 if (FunctionTemplate) { 10005 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10006 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 10007 return FunctionTemplate; 10008 } 10009 10010 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 10011 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 10012 } 10013 10014 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 10015 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 10016 10017 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 10018 // types. 10019 if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) { 10020 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 10021 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 10022 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 10023 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 10024 D.setInvalidType(); 10025 } 10026 } 10027 } 10028 } 10029 10030 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 10031 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 10032 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 10033 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 10034 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 10035 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 10036 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 10037 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 10038 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 10039 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 10040 AddToScope = false; 10041 } 10042 10043 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 10044 // that are run during load/unload. 10045 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 10046 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 10047 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10048 << 1; 10049 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10050 } 10051 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 10052 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 10053 << 2; 10054 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 10055 } 10056 } 10057 10058 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 10059 // definition. 10060 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 10061 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 10062 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 10063 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 10064 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 10065 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 10066 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 10067 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted: 10068 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted: 10069 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 10070 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 10071 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10072 break; 10073 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration: 10074 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 10075 << NBA->getSpelling(); 10076 break; 10077 case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition: 10078 break; 10079 } 10080 10081 return NewFD; 10082 } 10083 10084 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 10085 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 10086 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 10087 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 10088 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 10089 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 10090 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 10091 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 10092 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 10093 /// available since MS has removed the page. 10094 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10095 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 10096 if (!Method) 10097 return nullptr; 10098 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 10099 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10100 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10101 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10102 return NewAttr; 10103 } 10104 10105 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 10106 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 10107 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10108 return nullptr; 10109 10110 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 10111 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 10112 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 10113 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 10114 return NewAttr; 10115 } 10116 } 10117 return nullptr; 10118 } 10119 10120 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 10121 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 10122 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 10123 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 10124 /// 10125 /// \param FD Function being declared. 10126 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 10127 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 10128 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 10129 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10130 bool IsDefinition) { 10131 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 10132 return A; 10133 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 10134 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 10135 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 10136 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 10137 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 10138 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 10139 return nullptr; 10140 } 10141 10142 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 10143 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 10144 /// best-effort check. 10145 /// 10146 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 10147 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 10148 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 10149 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 10150 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 10151 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 10152 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10153 return true; 10154 10155 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 10156 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 10157 // 10158 // int f(); 10159 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 10160 // 10161 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 10162 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 10163 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 10164 return false; 10165 10166 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 10167 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 10168 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 10169 return false; 10170 10171 return true; 10172 } 10173 10174 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 10175 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 10176 /// 10177 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 10178 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 10179 /// same declaration name. 10180 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 10181 /// belongs to. 10182 /// 10183 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 10184 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 10185 return true; 10186 10187 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 10188 // permit cases like 10189 // 10190 // void func(); 10191 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 10192 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10193 // 10194 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10195 // 10196 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10197 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10198 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10199 // the way of access checks. 10200 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10201 return false; 10202 10203 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10204 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10205 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10206 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10207 PrevVD->getType()); 10208 } 10209 10210 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10211 /// validity. 10212 /// 10213 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10214 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10215 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10216 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10217 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10218 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10219 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10220 10221 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10222 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10223 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10224 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10225 return true; 10226 } 10227 10228 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10229 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10230 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10231 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10232 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10233 return true; 10234 } 10235 10236 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10237 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10238 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10239 << Feature << BareFeat; 10240 return true; 10241 } 10242 } 10243 return false; 10244 } 10245 10246 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10247 // multiversion functions. 10248 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10249 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10250 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10251 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10252 switch (Kind) { 10253 default: 10254 return false; 10255 case attr::Used: 10256 return MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10257 case attr::NonNull: 10258 case attr::NoThrow: 10259 return true; 10260 } 10261 } 10262 10263 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10264 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10265 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10266 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10267 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType = 10268 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10269 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10270 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType]( 10271 Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10272 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10273 << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType << A; 10274 if (CausedFD) 10275 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10276 return true; 10277 }; 10278 10279 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10280 switch (A->getKind()) { 10281 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10282 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10283 if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10284 MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10285 return Diagnose(S, A); 10286 break; 10287 case attr::Target: 10288 if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10289 return Diagnose(S, A); 10290 break; 10291 default: 10292 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVType)) 10293 return Diagnose(S, A); 10294 break; 10295 } 10296 } 10297 return false; 10298 } 10299 10300 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10301 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10302 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10303 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10304 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10305 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10306 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10307 enum DoesntSupport { 10308 FuncTemplates = 0, 10309 VirtFuncs = 1, 10310 DeducedReturn = 2, 10311 Constructors = 3, 10312 Destructors = 4, 10313 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10314 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10315 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10316 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10317 }; 10318 enum Different { 10319 CallingConv = 0, 10320 ReturnType = 1, 10321 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10322 InlineSpec = 3, 10323 StorageClass = 4, 10324 Linkage = 5, 10325 }; 10326 10327 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10328 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10329 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10330 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10331 return true; 10332 } 10333 10334 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10335 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10336 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10337 10338 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10339 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10340 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10341 << FuncTemplates; 10342 10343 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10344 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10345 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10346 << VirtFuncs; 10347 10348 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10349 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10350 << Constructors; 10351 10352 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10353 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10354 << Destructors; 10355 } 10356 10357 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10358 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10359 << DeletedFuncs; 10360 10361 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10362 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10363 << DefaultedFuncs; 10364 10365 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10366 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10367 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10368 10369 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10370 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10371 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10372 10373 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10374 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10375 << DeducedReturn; 10376 10377 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10378 if (OldFD) { 10379 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10380 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10381 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10382 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10383 10384 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10385 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10386 10387 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10388 10389 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10390 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10391 10392 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10393 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10394 10395 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10396 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10397 10398 if (OldFD->getStorageClass() != NewFD->getStorageClass()) 10399 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << StorageClass; 10400 10401 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10402 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10403 10404 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10405 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10406 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10407 return true; 10408 } 10409 return false; 10410 } 10411 10412 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10413 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10414 bool CausesMV, 10415 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10416 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10417 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10418 if (OldFD) 10419 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10420 return true; 10421 } 10422 10423 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType = 10424 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10425 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10426 10427 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10428 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType)) 10429 return true; 10430 10431 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVType)) 10432 return true; 10433 10434 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10435 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10436 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10437 10438 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10439 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10440 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10441 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10442 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10443 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10444 << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType), 10445 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10446 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10447 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10448 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType, 10449 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10450 } 10451 10452 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10453 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10454 /// 10455 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10456 /// 10457 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10458 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10459 MultiVersionKind MVType, 10460 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10461 assert(MVType != MultiVersionKind::None && 10462 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10463 10464 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10465 // function. 10466 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10467 return false; 10468 10469 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10470 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10471 return true; 10472 } 10473 10474 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVType)) { 10475 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10476 return true; 10477 } 10478 10479 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10480 return false; 10481 } 10482 10483 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10484 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10485 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10486 return true; 10487 } 10488 10489 return false; 10490 } 10491 10492 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10493 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10494 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10495 LookupResult &Previous) { 10496 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10497 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10498 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10499 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10500 10501 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10502 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10503 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10504 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10505 return false; 10506 10507 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10508 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10509 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10510 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10511 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10512 return true; 10513 } 10514 10515 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10516 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10517 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10518 return true; 10519 } 10520 10521 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10522 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10523 return true; 10524 } 10525 10526 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10527 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10528 Redeclaration = true; 10529 OldDecl = OldFD; 10530 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10531 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10532 return false; 10533 } 10534 10535 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10536 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10537 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10538 return true; 10539 } 10540 10541 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10542 10543 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10544 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10545 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10546 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10547 return true; 10548 } 10549 10550 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10551 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10552 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10553 // nothing after the fact. 10554 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10555 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10556 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10557 << 0; 10558 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10559 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10560 return true; 10561 } 10562 } 10563 10564 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10565 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10566 Redeclaration = false; 10567 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10568 OldDecl = nullptr; 10569 Previous.clear(); 10570 return false; 10571 } 10572 10573 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 10574 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 10575 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10576 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10577 MultiVersionKind NewMVType, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10578 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 10579 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10580 LookupResult &Previous) { 10581 10582 MultiVersionKind OldMVType = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10583 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 10584 if ((OldMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10585 NewMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target) || 10586 (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10587 OldMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10588 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10589 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10590 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10591 return true; 10592 } 10593 10594 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 10595 if (NewTA) { 10596 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10597 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10598 } 10599 10600 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 10601 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 10602 10603 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 10604 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 10605 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 10606 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 10607 if (!CurFD) 10608 continue; 10609 if (S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 10610 continue; 10611 10612 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target) { 10613 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10614 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 10615 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10616 Redeclaration = true; 10617 OldDecl = ND; 10618 return false; 10619 } 10620 10621 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10622 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 10623 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10624 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10625 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10626 return true; 10627 } 10628 } else { 10629 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10630 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10631 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 10632 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 10633 // the redeclaration errors. 10634 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10635 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 10636 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 10637 std::equal( 10638 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 10639 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 10640 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10641 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10642 })) { 10643 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10644 Redeclaration = true; 10645 OldDecl = ND; 10646 return false; 10647 } 10648 10649 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 10650 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 10651 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10652 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10653 return true; 10654 } 10655 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 10656 10657 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 10658 std::equal( 10659 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 10660 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 10661 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10662 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10663 })) { 10664 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10665 Redeclaration = true; 10666 OldDecl = ND; 10667 return false; 10668 } 10669 10670 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 10671 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10672 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10673 if (CurII == NewII) { 10674 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 10675 << NewII; 10676 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10677 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10678 return true; 10679 } 10680 } 10681 } 10682 } 10683 // If the two decls aren't the same MVType, there is no possible error 10684 // condition. 10685 } 10686 } 10687 10688 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 10689 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 10690 // handled in the attribute adding step. 10691 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10692 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10693 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10694 return true; 10695 } 10696 10697 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 10698 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVType)) { 10699 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10700 return true; 10701 } 10702 10703 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 10704 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 10705 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10706 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10707 Redeclaration = true; 10708 OldDecl = OldFD; 10709 return false; 10710 } 10711 10712 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10713 Redeclaration = false; 10714 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10715 OldDecl = nullptr; 10716 Previous.clear(); 10717 return false; 10718 } 10719 10720 10721 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 10722 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10723 /// 10724 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10725 /// 10726 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10727 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10728 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 10729 bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10730 LookupResult &Previous) { 10731 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10732 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10733 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10734 10735 // Mixing Multiversioning types is prohibited. 10736 if ((NewTA && NewCPUDisp) || (NewTA && NewCPUSpec) || 10737 (NewCPUDisp && NewCPUSpec)) { 10738 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10739 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10740 return true; 10741 } 10742 10743 MultiVersionKind MVType = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10744 10745 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 10746 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 10747 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 10748 if ((MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) || 10749 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10750 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) { 10751 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 10752 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10753 return true; 10754 } 10755 return false; 10756 } 10757 10758 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 10759 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 10760 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 10761 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 10762 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 10763 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) 10764 return false; 10765 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVType, NewTA); 10766 } 10767 10768 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 10769 10770 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) 10771 return false; 10772 10773 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) { 10774 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10775 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 10776 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10777 return true; 10778 } 10779 10780 // Handle the target potentially causes multiversioning case. 10781 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target) 10782 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 10783 Redeclaration, OldDecl, 10784 MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous); 10785 10786 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 10787 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 10788 // still compatible with previous declarations. 10789 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10790 S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType, NewTA, NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, Redeclaration, 10791 OldDecl, MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous); 10792 } 10793 10794 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 10795 /// 10796 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 10797 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 10798 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 10799 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 10800 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 10801 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 10802 /// via InstantiateDecl). 10803 /// 10804 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 10805 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 10806 /// previous declaration). 10807 /// 10808 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10809 /// 10810 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 10811 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10812 LookupResult &Previous, 10813 bool IsMemberSpecialization) { 10814 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 10815 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 10816 10817 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 10818 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 10819 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 10820 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10821 !Previous.isShadowed(); 10822 10823 bool Redeclaration = false; 10824 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 10825 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 10826 10827 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 10828 // the same name, if appropriate. 10829 if (!Previous.empty()) { 10830 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 10831 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 10832 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 10833 // function to the scope. 10834 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 10835 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10836 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 10837 Redeclaration = true; 10838 OldDecl = Candidate; 10839 } 10840 } else { 10841 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 10842 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 10843 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 10844 case Ovl_Match: 10845 Redeclaration = true; 10846 break; 10847 10848 case Ovl_NonFunction: 10849 Redeclaration = true; 10850 break; 10851 10852 case Ovl_Overload: 10853 Redeclaration = false; 10854 break; 10855 } 10856 } 10857 } 10858 10859 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 10860 if (!Redeclaration && 10861 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 10862 if (!Previous.empty()) { 10863 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 10864 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 10865 Redeclaration = true; 10866 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 10867 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10868 10869 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 10870 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 10871 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 10872 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 10873 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 10874 Redeclaration = false; 10875 OldDecl = nullptr; 10876 } 10877 } 10878 } 10879 } 10880 10881 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, 10882 MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous)) 10883 return Redeclaration; 10884 10885 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 10886 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 10887 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 10888 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10889 } 10890 10891 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 10892 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 10893 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 10894 // 10895 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 10896 // definition of a static member function. 10897 // 10898 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 10899 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 10900 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 10901 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 10902 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 10903 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 10904 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 10905 if (OldDecl) 10906 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 10907 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 10908 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 10909 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10910 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 10911 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 10912 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 10913 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 10914 10915 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 10916 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 10917 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 10918 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 10919 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 10920 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 10921 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 10922 10923 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 10924 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 10925 } 10926 } 10927 } 10928 10929 if (Redeclaration) { 10930 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 10931 // merged. 10932 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious)) { 10933 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10934 return Redeclaration; 10935 } 10936 10937 Previous.clear(); 10938 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 10939 10940 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 10941 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 10942 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 10943 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 10944 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 10945 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 10946 10947 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 10948 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 10949 // can add it as a redeclaration. 10950 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 10951 10952 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 10953 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 10954 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 10955 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 10956 } 10957 10958 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 10959 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 10960 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 10961 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 10962 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 10963 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 10964 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 10965 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 10966 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 10967 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 10968 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 10969 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 10970 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 10971 } 10972 } 10973 10974 } else { 10975 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 10976 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 10977 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 10978 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 10979 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 10980 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 10981 } 10982 } 10983 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 10984 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 10985 assert((Previous.empty() || 10986 llvm::any_of(Previous, 10987 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 10988 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 10989 })) && 10990 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 10991 10992 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 10993 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 10994 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 10995 }); 10996 10997 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 10998 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10999 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 11000 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 11001 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 11002 << false; 11003 11004 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 11005 } 11006 } 11007 11008 if (LangOpts.OpenMP) 11009 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD); 11010 11011 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 11012 11013 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11014 // C++-specific checks. 11015 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11016 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 11017 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11018 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 11019 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 11020 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 11021 11022 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 11023 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 11024 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 11025 DeclarationName Name 11026 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 11027 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 11028 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 11029 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 11030 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11031 return Redeclaration; 11032 } 11033 } 11034 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 11035 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 11036 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 11037 11038 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 11039 // explicitly specialized. 11040 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 11041 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 11042 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 11043 } 11044 11045 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 11046 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 11047 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 11048 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 11049 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 11050 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 11051 } 11052 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 11053 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 11054 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 11055 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 11056 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 11057 11058 if (Method->isStatic()) 11059 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 11060 } 11061 11062 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 11063 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 11064 11065 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 11066 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 11067 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11068 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11069 return Redeclaration; 11070 } 11071 11072 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 11073 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 11074 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 11075 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 11076 return Redeclaration; 11077 } 11078 11079 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 11080 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 11081 // during delayed parsing anyway. 11082 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 11083 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 11084 11085 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 11086 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 11087 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 11088 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 11089 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 11090 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 11091 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 11092 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 11093 << NewFD << R; 11094 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 11095 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11096 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 11097 } 11098 11099 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 11100 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 11101 // [is] part of the function type 11102 // 11103 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 11104 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 11105 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 11106 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 11107 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 11108 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 11109 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 11110 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 11111 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 11112 // restricted prior to C++17. 11113 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11114 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 11115 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 11116 T = T->getPointeeType(); 11117 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11118 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 11119 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11120 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 11121 return true; 11122 return false; 11123 }; 11124 11125 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11126 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 11127 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 11128 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 11129 if (AnyNoexcept) 11130 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 11131 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 11132 << NewFD; 11133 } 11134 11135 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 11136 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 11137 } 11138 return Redeclaration; 11139 } 11140 11141 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 11142 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 11143 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 11144 // constexpr is ill-formed. 11145 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 11146 // appear in a declaration of main. 11147 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 11148 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 11149 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 11150 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11151 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 11152 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 11153 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 11154 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 11155 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 11156 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 11157 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 11158 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 11159 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 11160 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 11161 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 11162 } 11163 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 11164 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 11165 << FD->isConsteval() 11166 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 11167 FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified); 11168 } 11169 11170 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 11171 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 11172 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 11173 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11174 return; 11175 } 11176 11177 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11178 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11179 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11180 11181 // Set default calling convention for main() 11182 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11183 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11184 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11185 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11186 } 11187 11188 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11189 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11190 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11191 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11192 11193 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11194 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11195 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11196 else { 11197 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11198 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11199 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11200 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11201 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11202 } 11203 } else { 11204 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11205 // set the flag which tells us that. 11206 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11207 11208 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11209 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11210 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11211 else { 11212 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11213 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11214 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11215 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11216 : FixItHint()); 11217 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11218 } 11219 } 11220 11221 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11222 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11223 11224 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11225 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11226 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11227 11228 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11229 11230 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11231 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11232 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11233 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11234 } 11235 11236 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11237 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11238 // getting shifty. 11239 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11240 HasExtraParameters = false; 11241 11242 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11243 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11244 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11245 nparams = 3; 11246 } 11247 11248 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11249 // if we had some location information about types. 11250 11251 QualType CharPP = 11252 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11253 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11254 11255 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11256 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11257 11258 bool mismatch = true; 11259 11260 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11261 mismatch = false; 11262 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11263 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11264 // char const ** 11265 // char const * const * 11266 // char * const * 11267 11268 QualifierCollector qs; 11269 const PointerType* PT; 11270 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11271 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11272 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11273 Context.CharTy)) { 11274 qs.removeConst(); 11275 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11276 } 11277 } 11278 11279 if (mismatch) { 11280 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11281 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11282 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11283 } 11284 } 11285 11286 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11287 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11288 } 11289 11290 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11291 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11292 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11293 } 11294 } 11295 11296 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) { 11297 11298 // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl 11299 if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain") 11300 return false; 11301 11302 // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl 11303 const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 11304 if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) 11305 return false; 11306 11307 // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain 11308 // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows 11309 if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86) 11310 return true; 11311 11312 return false; 11313 } 11314 11315 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11316 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11317 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11318 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11319 11320 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11321 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11322 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11323 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11324 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11325 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11326 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11327 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11328 11329 // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points 11330 if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) { 11331 if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) { 11332 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) { 11333 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType( 11334 FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall)); 11335 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11336 } 11337 } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11338 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, 11339 FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11340 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11341 } 11342 } 11343 11344 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11345 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11346 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11347 } 11348 } 11349 11350 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11351 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11352 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11353 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11354 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11355 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11356 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11357 // 11358 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11359 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11360 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11361 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11362 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11363 return true; 11364 } 11365 const Expr *Culprit; 11366 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11367 return false; 11368 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11369 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11370 return true; 11371 } 11372 11373 namespace { 11374 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11375 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11376 class SelfReferenceChecker 11377 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11378 Sema &S; 11379 Decl *OrigDecl; 11380 bool isRecordType; 11381 bool isPODType; 11382 bool isReferenceType; 11383 11384 bool isInitList; 11385 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11386 11387 public: 11388 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11389 11390 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11391 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11392 isPODType = false; 11393 isRecordType = false; 11394 isReferenceType = false; 11395 isInitList = false; 11396 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11397 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11398 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11399 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11400 } 11401 } 11402 11403 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11404 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11405 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11406 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11407 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11408 if (!InitList) { 11409 Visit(E); 11410 return; 11411 } 11412 11413 // Track and increment the index here. 11414 isInitList = true; 11415 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11416 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11417 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11418 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11419 } 11420 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11421 } 11422 11423 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11424 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11425 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11426 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11427 Expr *Base = E; 11428 bool ReferenceField = false; 11429 11430 // Get the field members used. 11431 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11432 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11433 if (!FD) 11434 return false; 11435 Fields.push_back(FD); 11436 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11437 ReferenceField = true; 11438 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11439 } 11440 11441 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11442 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11443 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11444 return false; 11445 11446 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11447 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11448 return true; 11449 11450 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11451 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11452 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11453 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11454 11455 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11456 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11457 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11458 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11459 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11460 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11461 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11462 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11463 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11464 return true; 11465 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11466 break; 11467 } 11468 11469 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11470 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11471 return true; 11472 } 11473 11474 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11475 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11476 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11477 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11478 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11479 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11480 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11481 return; 11482 } 11483 11484 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11485 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11486 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11487 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11488 return; 11489 } 11490 11491 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11492 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11493 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11494 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11495 return; 11496 } 11497 11498 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11499 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11500 return; 11501 } 11502 11503 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11504 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11505 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11506 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11507 return; 11508 } 11509 } 11510 11511 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11512 if (isInitList) { 11513 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11514 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11515 return; 11516 } 11517 11518 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11519 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11520 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 11521 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11522 return; 11523 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11524 } 11525 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 11526 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11527 return; 11528 } 11529 11530 Visit(E); 11531 } 11532 11533 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 11534 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 11535 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11536 if (isReferenceType) 11537 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 11538 } 11539 11540 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 11541 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 11542 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11543 return; 11544 } 11545 11546 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 11547 } 11548 11549 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 11550 if (isInitList) { 11551 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 11552 return; 11553 } 11554 11555 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 11556 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 11557 11558 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 11559 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 11560 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 11561 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 11562 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11563 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11564 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11565 Warn = false; 11566 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11567 } 11568 11569 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 11570 if (Warn) 11571 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11572 return; 11573 } 11574 11575 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 11576 // Visit that expression. 11577 Visit(Base); 11578 } 11579 11580 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 11581 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 11582 11583 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 11584 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 11585 11586 Visit(Callee); 11587 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 11588 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11589 } 11590 11591 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11592 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 11593 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 11594 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 11595 if (!isPODType) 11596 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11597 return; 11598 } 11599 11600 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 11601 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11602 return; 11603 } 11604 11605 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 11606 } 11607 11608 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 11609 11610 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 11611 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 11612 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 11613 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11614 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 11615 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 11616 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11617 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 11618 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11619 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 11620 return; 11621 } 11622 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 11623 } 11624 11625 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 11626 // Treat std::move as a use. 11627 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 11628 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 11629 return; 11630 } 11631 11632 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 11633 } 11634 11635 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 11636 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 11637 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 11638 Visit(E->getRHS()); 11639 return; 11640 } 11641 11642 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 11643 } 11644 11645 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 11646 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 11647 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 11648 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 11649 Visit(E->getCond()); 11650 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 11651 } 11652 11653 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 11654 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 11655 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 11656 unsigned diag; 11657 if (isReferenceType) { 11658 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 11659 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 11660 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 11661 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11662 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11663 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 11664 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 11665 } else { 11666 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 11667 return; 11668 } 11669 11670 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 11671 S.PDiag(diag) 11672 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 11673 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 11674 } 11675 }; 11676 11677 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 11678 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 11679 bool DirectInit) { 11680 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 11681 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 11682 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 11683 return; 11684 11685 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11686 11687 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 11688 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 11689 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 11690 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 11691 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 11692 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 11693 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 11694 return; 11695 11696 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 11697 } 11698 } // end anonymous namespace 11699 11700 namespace { 11701 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 11702 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 11703 struct VarDeclOrName { 11704 VarDecl *VDecl; 11705 DeclarationName Name; 11706 11707 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 11708 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 11709 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 11710 } 11711 }; 11712 } // end anonymous namespace 11713 11714 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 11715 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 11716 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 11717 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 11718 Expr *Init) { 11719 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 11720 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 11721 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 11722 11723 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 11724 11725 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 11726 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 11727 11728 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 11729 if (!Init) { 11730 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 11731 11732 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 11733 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 11734 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 11735 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 11736 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 11737 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 11738 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 11739 return QualType(); 11740 } 11741 } 11742 11743 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 11744 if (Init) 11745 DeduceInits = Init; 11746 11747 if (DirectInit) { 11748 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 11749 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 11750 } 11751 11752 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 11753 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 11754 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 11755 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 11756 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 11757 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 11758 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 11759 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 11760 InitsCopy); 11761 } 11762 11763 if (DirectInit) { 11764 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 11765 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 11766 } 11767 11768 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 11769 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 11770 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 11771 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 11772 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 11773 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 11774 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 11775 << VN << Type << Range; 11776 return QualType(); 11777 } 11778 11779 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 11780 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 11781 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 11782 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 11783 << VN << Type << Range; 11784 return QualType(); 11785 } 11786 11787 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 11788 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 11789 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 11790 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 11791 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 11792 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 11793 return QualType(); 11794 } 11795 11796 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 11797 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 11798 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 11799 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 11800 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 11801 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 11802 return QualType(); 11803 } 11804 Init = Result.get(); 11805 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 11806 } 11807 11808 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 11809 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 11810 // is present, e has type cv A 11811 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 11812 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 11813 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 11814 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 11815 Type.getQualifiers()); 11816 11817 QualType DeducedType; 11818 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 11819 if (!IsInitCapture) 11820 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 11821 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 11822 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 11823 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 11824 << VN 11825 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 11826 : DeduceInit->getType()) 11827 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 11828 else 11829 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 11830 << VN << TSI->getType() 11831 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 11832 : DeduceInit->getType()) 11833 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 11834 } 11835 11836 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 11837 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 11838 // checks. 11839 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 11840 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 11841 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 11842 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 11843 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 11844 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 11845 } 11846 11847 return DeducedType; 11848 } 11849 11850 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 11851 Expr *Init) { 11852 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 11853 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 11854 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 11855 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 11856 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 11857 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11858 return true; 11859 } 11860 11861 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 11862 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 11863 11864 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 11865 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 11866 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11867 11868 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 11869 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 11870 11871 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 11872 // the previously declared type. 11873 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 11874 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 11875 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 11876 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 11877 } 11878 11879 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 11880 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 11881 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 11882 } 11883 11884 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 11885 SourceLocation Loc) { 11886 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 11887 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 11888 11889 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 11890 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 11891 11892 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 11893 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 11894 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 11895 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 11896 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 11897 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 11898 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 11899 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 11900 continue; 11901 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 11902 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 11903 } 11904 return; 11905 } 11906 11907 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 11908 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 11909 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 11910 NTCUK_Init); 11911 } else { 11912 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 11913 // object. 11914 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 11915 // copy-elision. 11916 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 11917 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 11918 } 11919 } 11920 11921 namespace { 11922 11923 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 11924 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 11925 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 11926 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 11927 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 11928 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 11929 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 11930 } 11931 11932 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 11933 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 11934 void> { 11935 using Super = 11936 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 11937 void>; 11938 11939 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 11940 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 11941 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 11942 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 11943 11944 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 11945 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11946 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 11947 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 11948 InNonTrivialUnion); 11949 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11950 } 11951 11952 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11953 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11954 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11955 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11956 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 11957 } 11958 11959 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11960 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11961 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11962 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 11963 } 11964 11965 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11966 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 11967 if (RD->isUnion()) { 11968 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 11969 bool IsUnion = false; 11970 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 11971 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 11972 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 11973 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 11974 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 11975 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 11976 } 11977 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 11978 } 11979 11980 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11981 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11982 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 11983 11984 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 11985 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 11986 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11987 } 11988 11989 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11990 11991 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 11992 // non-trivial C union. 11993 QualType OrigTy; 11994 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 11995 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 11996 Sema &S; 11997 }; 11998 11999 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 12000 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 12001 using Super = 12002 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 12003 12004 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 12005 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12006 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 12007 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12008 12009 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 12010 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12011 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12012 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12013 InNonTrivialUnion); 12014 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12015 } 12016 12017 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12018 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12019 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12020 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12021 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12022 } 12023 12024 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12025 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12026 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12027 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 12028 } 12029 12030 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12031 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12032 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12033 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12034 bool IsUnion = false; 12035 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12036 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12037 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12038 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12039 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12040 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12041 } 12042 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12043 } 12044 12045 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12046 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12047 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12048 12049 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12050 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12051 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12052 } 12053 12054 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12055 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12056 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12057 12058 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12059 // non-trivial C union. 12060 QualType OrigTy; 12061 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12062 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12063 Sema &S; 12064 }; 12065 12066 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 12067 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 12068 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 12069 12070 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 12071 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12072 Sema &S) 12073 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 12074 12075 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12076 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12077 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 12078 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 12079 InNonTrivialUnion); 12080 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12081 } 12082 12083 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12084 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12085 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12086 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12087 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12088 } 12089 12090 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12091 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12092 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12093 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 12094 } 12095 12096 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 12097 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 12098 if (RD->isUnion()) { 12099 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 12100 bool IsUnion = false; 12101 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 12102 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 12103 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 12104 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 12105 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 12106 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 12107 } 12108 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 12109 } 12110 12111 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 12112 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 12113 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 12114 12115 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 12116 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 12117 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 12118 } 12119 12120 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 12121 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12122 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12123 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 12124 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 12125 12126 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 12127 // non-trivial C union. 12128 QualType OrigTy; 12129 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 12130 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 12131 Sema &S; 12132 }; 12133 12134 } // namespace 12135 12136 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 12137 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 12138 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 12139 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12140 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 12141 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 12142 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 12143 12144 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 12145 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12146 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12147 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12148 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 12149 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 12150 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12151 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12152 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 12153 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 12154 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 12155 } 12156 12157 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 12158 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 12159 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 12160 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 12161 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 12162 // the initializer. 12163 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12164 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 12165 return; 12166 } 12167 12168 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12169 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 12170 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 12171 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 12172 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 12173 return; 12174 } 12175 12176 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 12177 if (!VDecl) { 12178 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 12179 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 12180 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12181 return; 12182 } 12183 12184 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 12185 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12186 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 12187 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 12188 // TypoExpr. 12189 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 12190 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 12191 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 12192 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 12193 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12194 return; 12195 } 12196 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 12197 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 12198 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12199 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 12200 return; 12201 } 12202 Init = Res.get(); 12203 12204 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 12205 return; 12206 } 12207 12208 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 12209 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12210 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12211 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12212 return; 12213 } 12214 12215 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12216 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12217 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12218 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12219 return; 12220 } 12221 12222 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12223 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12224 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12225 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12226 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12227 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12228 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12229 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12230 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12231 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12232 return; 12233 } 12234 12235 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12236 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12237 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12238 AbstractVariableType)) 12239 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12240 } 12241 12242 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12243 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12244 // handle the situation. 12245 if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) 12246 if (Def != VDecl && 12247 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12248 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12249 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12250 return; 12251 12252 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12253 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12254 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12255 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12256 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12257 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12258 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12259 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12260 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12261 // 12262 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12263 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12264 // declaration with an initializer. 12265 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12266 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12267 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12268 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12269 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12270 << 0; 12271 return; 12272 } 12273 12274 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12275 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12276 12277 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12278 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12279 return; 12280 } 12281 } 12282 12283 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12284 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12285 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12286 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12287 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12288 return; 12289 } 12290 12291 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12292 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12293 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12294 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12295 return; 12296 } 12297 12298 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12299 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12300 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12301 12302 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12303 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12304 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12305 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12306 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12307 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12308 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12309 return; 12310 } 12311 Init = Result.get(); 12312 } 12313 12314 // Perform the initialization. 12315 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12316 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12317 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12318 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12319 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12320 12321 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12322 if (CXXDirectInit) 12323 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12324 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12325 12326 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12327 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12328 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12329 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12330 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12331 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12332 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12333 }); 12334 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12335 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12336 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12337 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12338 } 12339 } 12340 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12341 return; 12342 12343 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12344 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12345 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12346 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12347 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12348 // If the provied initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12349 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12350 auto RecoveryExpr = 12351 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12352 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12353 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12354 return; 12355 } 12356 12357 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12358 } 12359 12360 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12361 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12362 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12363 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12364 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12365 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12366 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12367 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12368 12369 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12370 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12371 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12372 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12373 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12374 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12375 12376 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12377 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12378 12379 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12380 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12381 12382 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12383 // Although this code can still have problems: 12384 // id x = self.weakProp; 12385 // id y = self.weakProp; 12386 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12387 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12388 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12389 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12390 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12391 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12392 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12393 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12394 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12395 } 12396 12397 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12398 // 12399 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12400 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12401 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12402 // 12403 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12404 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12405 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12406 // 12407 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12408 ExprResult Result = 12409 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12410 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12411 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12412 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12413 return; 12414 } 12415 Init = Result.get(); 12416 12417 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12418 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12419 12420 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12421 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12422 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12423 // do nothing 12424 12425 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12426 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12427 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12428 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12429 12430 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12431 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12432 // do nothing 12433 12434 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12435 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12436 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12437 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12438 12439 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12440 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12441 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12442 // constant expressions. 12443 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12444 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12445 const Expr *Culprit; 12446 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12447 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12448 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12449 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12450 } 12451 } 12452 12453 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12454 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12455 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12456 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12457 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12458 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12459 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12460 // 12461 // struct S { 12462 // static const int value = 17; 12463 // }; 12464 12465 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12466 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12467 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12468 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12469 // 12470 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12471 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12472 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12473 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12474 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12475 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12476 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12477 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12478 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12479 12480 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12481 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12482 12483 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12484 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12485 // type. 12486 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12487 12488 // Require constness. 12489 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12490 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12491 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12492 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12493 12494 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12495 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12496 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12497 SourceLocation Loc; 12498 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12499 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12500 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12501 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12502 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12503 ; // Nothing to check. 12504 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12505 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12506 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12507 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12508 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12509 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12510 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12511 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12512 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12513 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12514 } else { 12515 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12516 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 12517 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12518 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12519 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12520 } 12521 12522 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 12523 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 12524 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 12525 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 12526 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 12527 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 12528 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12529 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12530 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 12531 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12532 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12533 } else { 12534 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 12535 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12536 12537 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12538 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12539 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12540 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12541 } 12542 } 12543 12544 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 12545 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 12546 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 12547 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 12548 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12549 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 12550 12551 } else { 12552 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 12553 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12554 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12555 } 12556 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 12557 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 12558 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 12559 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 12560 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 12561 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 12562 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 12563 // C++ rules. 12564 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 12565 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 12566 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 12567 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 12568 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 12569 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 12570 12571 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 12572 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 12573 // __declspec(dllexport). 12574 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 12575 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 12576 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 12577 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 12578 12579 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 12580 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12581 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12582 } 12583 12584 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12585 if (!InitType.isNull() && 12586 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12587 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 12588 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 12589 12590 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 12591 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 12592 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 12593 // 12594 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 12595 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 12596 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 12597 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 12598 // special case code. 12599 12600 // C++ 8.5p11: 12601 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 12602 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 12603 // class type. 12604 if (CXXDirectInit) { 12605 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 12606 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12607 } else if (DirectInit) { 12608 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 12609 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 12610 } 12611 12612 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 12613 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl); 12614 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 12615 } 12616 12617 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 12618 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to return to some form 12619 /// of sanity. 12620 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 12621 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 12622 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 12623 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12624 12625 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12626 if (!VD) return; 12627 12628 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12629 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 12630 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 12631 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 12632 12633 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12634 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12635 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12636 return; 12637 } 12638 12639 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 12640 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 12641 12642 // Require a complete type. 12643 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 12644 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 12645 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12646 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12647 return; 12648 } 12649 12650 // Require a non-abstract type. 12651 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 12652 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12653 AbstractVariableType)) { 12654 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12655 return; 12656 } 12657 12658 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 12659 // though. 12660 } 12661 12662 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 12663 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 12664 if (!RealDecl) 12665 return; 12666 12667 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12668 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 12669 12670 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 12671 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12672 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 12673 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12674 return; 12675 } 12676 12677 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 12678 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 12679 return; 12680 12681 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 12682 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 12683 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 12684 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 12685 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 12686 // member. 12687 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 12688 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 12689 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 12690 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 12691 // a definition there. 12692 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 12693 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 12694 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 12695 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 12696 << Var; 12697 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12698 return; 12699 } 12700 } else { 12701 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 12702 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12703 return; 12704 } 12705 } 12706 12707 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 12708 // be initialized. 12709 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12710 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 12711 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 12712 bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false; 12713 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 12714 for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) { 12715 if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 && 12716 Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() == 12717 LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12718 HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true; 12719 } 12720 } 12721 } 12722 if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) { 12723 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 12724 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12725 return; 12726 } 12727 } 12728 12729 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12730 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 12731 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 12732 << Var; 12733 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12734 return; 12735 } 12736 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 12737 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12738 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12739 return; 12740 } 12741 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 12742 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 12743 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 12744 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12745 return; 12746 } 12747 } 12748 // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks. 12749 return; 12750 } 12751 12752 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 12753 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 12754 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12755 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 12756 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 12757 12758 12759 switch (DefKind) { 12760 case VarDecl::Definition: 12761 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 12762 break; 12763 12764 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 12765 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 12766 // a declaration. 12767 // 12768 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12769 12770 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 12771 // It's only a declaration. 12772 12773 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 12774 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 12775 // object shall be complete. 12776 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 12777 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12778 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12779 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 12780 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12781 12782 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 12783 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12784 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12785 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12786 AbstractVariableType)) 12787 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12788 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12789 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 12790 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 12791 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 12792 } 12793 12794 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() && 12795 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12796 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 12797 12798 return; 12799 12800 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 12801 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 12802 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 12803 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 12804 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 12805 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 12806 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 12807 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 12808 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 12809 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 12810 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 12811 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 12812 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12813 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12814 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 12815 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 12816 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 12817 // NOTE: code such as the following 12818 // static struct s; 12819 // struct s { int a; }; 12820 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 12821 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 12822 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 12823 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 12824 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12825 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 12826 } 12827 } 12828 12829 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 12830 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 12831 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 12832 return; 12833 } 12834 12835 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 12836 // definitions with incomplete array type. 12837 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 12838 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 12839 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 12840 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12841 return; 12842 } 12843 12844 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 12845 // definitions with reference type. 12846 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 12847 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 12848 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 12849 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12850 return; 12851 } 12852 12853 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 12854 // variable with dependent type. 12855 if (Type->isDependentType()) 12856 return; 12857 12858 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 12859 return; 12860 12861 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 12862 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 12863 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 12864 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12865 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12866 return; 12867 } 12868 } else { 12869 return; 12870 } 12871 12872 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12873 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12874 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12875 AbstractVariableType)) { 12876 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12877 return; 12878 } 12879 12880 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 12881 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 12882 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 12883 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 12884 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 12885 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 12886 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 12887 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 12888 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 12889 // types and is declared without an initializer. 12890 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 12891 if (const RecordType *Record 12892 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12893 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 12894 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 12895 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 12896 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 12897 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 12898 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12899 } 12900 } 12901 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 12902 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 12903 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 12904 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 12905 return; 12906 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 12907 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 12908 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 12909 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 12910 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 12911 // type shall have a user-declared default 12912 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 12913 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 12914 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 12915 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 12916 // program is ill-formed. 12917 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 12918 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 12919 // default-initialized; [...]. 12920 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 12921 InitializationKind Kind 12922 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 12923 12924 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 12925 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 12926 12927 if (Init.get()) { 12928 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 12929 // This is important for template substitution. 12930 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12931 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 12932 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 12933 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 12934 auto RecoveryExpr = 12935 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 12936 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12937 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12938 } 12939 12940 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 12941 } 12942 } 12943 12944 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 12945 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 12946 if (!D) 12947 return; 12948 12949 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12950 if (!VD) { 12951 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 12952 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12953 return; 12954 } 12955 12956 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 12957 12958 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 12959 int Error = -1; 12960 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 12961 case SC_None: 12962 break; 12963 case SC_Extern: 12964 Error = 0; 12965 break; 12966 case SC_Static: 12967 Error = 1; 12968 break; 12969 case SC_PrivateExtern: 12970 Error = 2; 12971 break; 12972 case SC_Auto: 12973 Error = 3; 12974 break; 12975 case SC_Register: 12976 Error = 4; 12977 break; 12978 } 12979 12980 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't. 12981 switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) { 12982 case TSCS_thread_local: 12983 Error = 6; 12984 break; 12985 case TSCS___thread: 12986 case TSCS__Thread_local: 12987 case TSCS_unspecified: 12988 break; 12989 } 12990 12991 if (Error != -1) { 12992 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 12993 << VD << Error; 12994 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12995 } 12996 } 12997 12998 StmtResult 12999 Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 13000 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 13001 ParsedAttributes &Attrs, 13002 SourceLocation AttrEnd) { 13003 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 13004 // A range-based for statement of the form 13005 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13006 // is equivalent to 13007 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 13008 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 13009 13010 const char *PrevSpec; 13011 unsigned DiagID; 13012 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 13013 getPrintingPolicy()); 13014 13015 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::ForInit); 13016 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 13017 D.takeAttributes(Attrs, AttrEnd); 13018 13019 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 13020 IdentLoc); 13021 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 13022 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 13023 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 13024 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 13025 AttrEnd.isValid() ? AttrEnd : IdentLoc); 13026 } 13027 13028 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 13029 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 13030 13031 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var); 13032 13033 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13034 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 13035 // initialiser 13036 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 13037 !var->hasInit()) { 13038 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 13039 << 1 /*Init*/; 13040 var->setInvalidDecl(); 13041 return; 13042 } 13043 } 13044 13045 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 13046 // local retaining variable. 13047 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 13048 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 13049 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 13050 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 13051 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 13052 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 13053 break; 13054 13055 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 13056 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 13057 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13058 break; 13059 } 13060 } 13061 13062 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 13063 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 13064 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13065 13066 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 13067 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 13068 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 13069 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 13070 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 13071 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13072 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 13073 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 13074 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 13075 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 13076 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 13077 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 13078 var->getLocation())) { 13079 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 13080 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 13081 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 13082 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 13083 13084 if (!prev) { 13085 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 13086 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 13087 << /* variable */ 0; 13088 } 13089 } 13090 13091 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 13092 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 13093 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 13094 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 13095 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 13096 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 13097 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 13098 return *CacheHasConstInit; 13099 }; 13100 13101 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 13102 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 13103 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 13104 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 13105 // have a non-trivial destructor. 13106 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 13107 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13108 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13109 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 13110 if (!checkConstInit()) { 13111 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 13112 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 13113 // initialization. 13114 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 13115 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 13116 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13117 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13118 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 13119 } 13120 } 13121 } 13122 13123 13124 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 13125 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 13126 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 13127 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 13128 if (NumInits > 2) 13129 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 13130 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 13131 if (!Init) 13132 break; 13133 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13134 if (!SL) 13135 break; 13136 13137 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 13138 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 13139 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 13140 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 13141 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 13142 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 13143 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 13144 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 13145 if (!Init) 13146 break; 13147 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 13148 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 13149 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 13150 break; 13151 } 13152 } 13153 13154 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 13155 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 13156 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 13157 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 13158 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 13159 13160 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 13161 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 13162 << Hints; 13163 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 13164 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 13165 } 13166 // In any case, stop now. 13167 break; 13168 } 13169 } 13170 } 13171 13172 13173 QualType type = var->getType(); 13174 13175 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 13176 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 13177 13178 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 13179 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 13180 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 13181 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 13182 bool HasConstInit = true; 13183 13184 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 13185 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init && 13186 !Init->isValueDependent() && 13187 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 13188 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 13189 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 13190 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 13191 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 13192 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 13193 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13194 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13195 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13196 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13197 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13198 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13199 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13200 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13201 13202 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13203 // constant initializer. 13204 if (HasConstInit) { 13205 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13206 Notes.clear(); 13207 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13208 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13209 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13210 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13211 } 13212 } else { 13213 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13214 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13215 } 13216 13217 if (HasConstInit) { 13218 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13219 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13220 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13221 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13222 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13223 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13224 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13225 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13226 Notes.clear(); 13227 } 13228 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13229 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13230 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13231 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13232 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13233 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13234 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13235 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13236 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13237 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13238 for (auto &it : Notes) 13239 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13240 } else if (IsGlobal && 13241 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13242 var->getLocation())) { 13243 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13244 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13245 // warned about them. 13246 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13247 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13248 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13249 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13250 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13251 if (!checkConstInit()) 13252 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13253 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13254 } 13255 } 13256 } 13257 13258 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 13259 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13260 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 13261 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 13262 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 13263 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) { 13264 if (HasConstInit) 13265 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 13266 else { 13267 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13268 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13269 } 13270 } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) { 13271 Stack = &DataSegStack; 13272 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13273 } else { 13274 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 13275 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 13276 } 13277 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13278 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 13279 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13280 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 13281 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 13282 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 13283 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 13284 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13285 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 13286 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 13287 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 13288 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 13289 } 13290 13291 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 13292 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 13293 // attribute. 13294 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 13295 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 13296 CurInitSegLoc, 13297 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13298 } 13299 13300 // All the following checks are C++ only. 13301 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13302 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 13303 // current module. 13304 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13305 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13306 return; 13307 } 13308 13309 // Require the destructor. 13310 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13311 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13312 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13313 13314 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13315 // module. 13316 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13317 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13318 13319 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13320 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13321 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13322 } 13323 13324 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13325 /// dllexport/import function. 13326 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13327 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13328 13329 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13330 13331 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13332 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13333 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13334 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13335 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13336 } 13337 13338 if (!FD) 13339 return; 13340 13341 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13342 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13343 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13344 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13345 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13346 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13347 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13348 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13349 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13350 13351 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13352 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13353 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13354 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13355 13356 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13357 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13358 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13359 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13360 } 13361 } 13362 13363 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13364 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13365 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13366 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13367 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13368 13369 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13370 if (!VD) 13371 return; 13372 13373 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13374 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13375 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13376 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13377 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13378 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13379 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13380 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13381 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13382 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13383 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13384 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13385 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13386 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13387 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13388 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13389 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13390 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13391 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13392 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13393 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13394 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13395 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13396 } 13397 13398 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13399 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13400 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13401 } 13402 } 13403 13404 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13405 13406 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13407 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13408 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13409 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13410 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13411 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13412 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) { 13413 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13414 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13415 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13416 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13417 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13418 } 13419 } 13420 } 13421 13422 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13423 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13424 13425 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13426 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13427 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13428 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13429 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13430 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13431 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13432 13433 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13434 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13435 13436 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13437 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13438 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13439 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13440 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13441 // with a warning. 13442 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13443 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13444 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13445 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13446 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13447 13448 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13449 IsClassTemplateMember 13450 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13451 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13452 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13453 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13454 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13455 } 13456 } 13457 13458 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13459 // isn't exported with the variable. 13460 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13461 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13462 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13463 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13464 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13465 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13466 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13467 } else { 13468 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13469 << DLLAttr; 13470 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13471 } 13472 } 13473 13474 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13475 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13476 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13477 << Attr; 13478 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13479 } 13480 } 13481 if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) { 13482 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13483 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition) 13484 << Attr; 13485 VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>(); 13486 } 13487 } 13488 13489 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13490 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13491 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13492 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13493 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13494 13495 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13496 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13497 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13498 13499 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13500 // tag values. 13501 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13502 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13503 return; 13504 13505 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13506 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13507 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13508 continue; 13509 } 13510 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13511 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13512 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13513 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13514 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13515 continue; 13516 } 13517 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 13518 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13519 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 13520 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13521 continue; 13522 } 13523 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 13524 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 13525 MagicValue, 13526 I->getMatchingCType(), 13527 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 13528 I->getMustBeNull()); 13529 } 13530 } 13531 13532 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 13533 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 13534 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 13535 } 13536 13537 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 13538 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13539 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 13540 13541 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 13542 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 13543 13544 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13545 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13546 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 13547 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 13548 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 13549 13550 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13551 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 13552 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 13553 // to perform. 13554 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 13555 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 13556 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 13557 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 13558 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 13559 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 13560 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 13561 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 13562 13563 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 13564 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 13565 // declaration in the same group. 13566 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 13567 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 13568 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 13569 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13570 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13571 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 13572 } 13573 13574 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 13575 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 13576 // declarator in the same group. 13577 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 13578 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 13579 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 13580 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 13581 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 13582 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13583 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13584 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 13585 } 13586 } 13587 } 13588 13589 Decls.push_back(D); 13590 } 13591 } 13592 13593 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 13594 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 13595 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 13596 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 13597 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13598 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 13599 } 13600 } 13601 13602 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 13603 } 13604 13605 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 13606 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 13607 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 13608 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13609 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 13610 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 13611 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 13612 if (Group.size() > 1) { 13613 QualType Deduced; 13614 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 13615 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13616 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 13617 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 13618 break; 13619 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 13620 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 13621 continue; 13622 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 13623 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 13624 DeducedDecl = D; 13625 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 13626 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 13627 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13628 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 13629 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 13630 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 13631 << D->getDeclName(); 13632 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 13633 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13634 if (D->getInit()) 13635 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13636 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13637 break; 13638 } 13639 } 13640 } 13641 13642 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 13643 13644 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 13645 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 13646 } 13647 13648 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 13649 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 13650 } 13651 13652 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13653 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 13654 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 13655 return; 13656 13657 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 13658 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 13659 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 13660 Group[0]->getLocation())) 13661 return; 13662 13663 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 13664 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 13665 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 13666 // additional declaration references: 13667 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 13668 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 13669 // 'struct S *pS;' 13670 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 13671 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 13672 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 13673 Group = Group.slice(1); 13674 } 13675 } 13676 13677 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 13678 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 13679 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 13680 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 13681 } 13682 13683 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 13684 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 13685 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 13686 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 13687 // parameter. 13688 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13689 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 13690 13691 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 13692 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 13693 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 13694 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 13695 } 13696 13697 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 13698 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 13699 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 13700 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 13701 break; 13702 13703 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 13704 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 13705 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 13706 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 13707 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 13708 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 13709 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 13710 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 13711 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 13712 break; 13713 13714 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 13715 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 13716 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 13717 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 13718 break; 13719 } 13720 } 13721 13722 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 13723 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 13724 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 13725 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 13726 13727 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 13728 13729 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 13730 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 13731 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 13732 SC = SC_Register; 13733 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 13734 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 13735 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13736 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 13737 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 13738 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 13739 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 13740 } 13741 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13742 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 13743 SC = SC_Auto; 13744 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 13745 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 13746 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 13747 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 13748 } 13749 13750 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 13751 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 13752 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 13753 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 13754 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 13755 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 13756 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 13757 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 13758 << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()); 13759 13760 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 13761 13762 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 13763 13764 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 13765 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 13766 13767 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 13768 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 13769 if (II) { 13770 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 13771 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 13772 LookupName(R, S); 13773 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 13774 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 13775 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 13776 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 13777 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 13778 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 13779 PrevDecl = nullptr; 13780 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 13781 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 13782 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 13783 13784 // Recover by removing the name 13785 II = nullptr; 13786 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 13787 D.setInvalidType(true); 13788 } 13789 } 13790 } 13791 13792 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 13793 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 13794 // looking like class members in C++. 13795 ParmVarDecl *New = 13796 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 13797 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 13798 13799 if (D.isInvalidType()) 13800 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13801 13802 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 13803 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 13804 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 13805 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 13806 13807 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 13808 S->AddDecl(New); 13809 if (II) 13810 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 13811 13812 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 13813 13814 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 13815 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 13816 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 13817 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 13818 13819 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 13820 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 13821 } 13822 13823 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 13824 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 13825 13826 return New; 13827 } 13828 13829 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 13830 /// typedef. 13831 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 13832 SourceLocation Loc, 13833 QualType T) { 13834 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 13835 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 13836 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 13837 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 13838 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 13839 SC_None, nullptr); 13840 Param->setImplicit(); 13841 return Param; 13842 } 13843 13844 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 13845 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 13846 // will already have done so in the template itself. 13847 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 13848 return; 13849 13850 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 13851 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 13852 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 13853 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 13854 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 13855 } 13856 } 13857 } 13858 13859 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 13860 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 13861 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 13862 return; 13863 13864 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 13865 // threshold. 13866 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 13867 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 13868 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 13869 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 13870 } 13871 13872 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 13873 // threshold. 13874 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 13875 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 13876 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 13877 continue; 13878 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 13879 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 13880 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 13881 << Parameter << Size; 13882 } 13883 } 13884 13885 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 13886 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 13887 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 13888 StorageClass SC) { 13889 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 13890 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 13891 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 13892 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 13893 13894 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 13895 13896 // Special cases for arrays: 13897 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 13898 // - otherwise, it's an error 13899 if (T->isArrayType()) { 13900 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 13901 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 13902 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 13903 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 13904 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 13905 else 13906 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 13907 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 13908 } 13909 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 13910 } else { 13911 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 13912 } 13913 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 13914 } 13915 13916 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 13917 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 13918 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 13919 13920 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 13921 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 13922 // lambda scope. 13923 if (New->isParameterPack()) 13924 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 13925 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 13926 13927 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 13928 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 13929 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 13930 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 13931 13932 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 13933 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 13934 // the class has been completely parsed. 13935 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 13936 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13937 AbstractParamType)) 13938 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13939 13940 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 13941 // passed by reference. 13942 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 13943 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 13944 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 13945 Diag(NameLoc, 13946 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 13947 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 13948 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 13949 New->setType(T); 13950 } 13951 13952 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 13953 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 13954 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 13955 // an address space. 13956 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 13957 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 13958 // to be qualified with an address space. 13959 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13960 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 13961 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 13962 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13963 } 13964 13965 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 13966 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 13967 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 13968 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13969 } 13970 13971 return New; 13972 } 13973 13974 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 13975 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 13976 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 13977 13978 // Verify 6.9.1p6: 'every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared' 13979 // for a K&R function. 13980 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 13981 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 13982 --i; 13983 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 13984 SmallString<256> Code; 13985 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 13986 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 13987 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 13988 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 13989 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 13990 13991 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 13992 // type. 13993 AttributeFactory attrs; 13994 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 13995 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 13996 unsigned DiagID; // unused 13997 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 13998 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 13999 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 14000 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14001 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14002 Declarator ParamD(DS, DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList); 14003 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 14004 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 14005 } 14006 } 14007 } 14008 } 14009 14010 Decl * 14011 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 14012 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 14013 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14014 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 14015 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 14016 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 14017 14018 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 14019 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 14020 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 14021 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 14022 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 14023 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 14024 // `omp begin declare variant`. 14025 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 14026 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 14027 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 14028 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 14029 14030 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition); 14031 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 14032 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody); 14033 14034 if (!Bases.empty()) 14035 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 14036 14037 return Dcl; 14038 } 14039 14040 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 14041 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 14042 } 14043 14044 static bool 14045 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 14046 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 14047 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 14048 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14049 return false; 14050 14051 // Or declarations that aren't global. 14052 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 14053 return false; 14054 14055 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 14056 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 14057 return false; 14058 14059 // Don't warn about 'main'. 14060 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 14061 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 14062 if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main")) 14063 return false; 14064 14065 // Don't warn about inline functions. 14066 if (FD->isInlined()) 14067 return false; 14068 14069 // Don't warn about function templates. 14070 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14071 return false; 14072 14073 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 14074 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 14075 return false; 14076 14077 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 14078 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 14079 return false; 14080 14081 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 14082 if (FD->isDeleted()) 14083 return false; 14084 14085 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 14086 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 14087 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 14088 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 14089 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14090 continue; 14091 14092 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 14093 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 14094 } 14095 14096 return true; 14097 } 14098 14099 void 14100 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 14101 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 14102 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14103 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 14104 if (!Definition && 14105 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 14106 return; 14107 14108 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 14109 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14110 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 14111 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 14112 // the same class, is OK. 14113 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 14114 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 14115 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 14116 return; 14117 } 14118 } 14119 } 14120 14121 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 14122 return; 14123 14124 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 14125 // definition. 14126 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 14127 return; 14128 14129 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 14130 // a template, skip the new definition. 14131 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 14132 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 14133 Definition->isInlined() || 14134 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 14135 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 14136 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 14137 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 14138 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 14139 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 14140 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 14141 return; 14142 } 14143 14144 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 14145 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 14146 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 14147 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 14148 else 14149 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 14150 14151 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 14152 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14153 } 14154 14155 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 14156 Sema &S) { 14157 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 14158 14159 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 14160 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 14161 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 14162 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 14163 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 14164 14165 if (LCD == LCD_None) 14166 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 14167 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 14168 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 14169 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 14170 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 14171 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 14172 14173 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 14174 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 14175 14176 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 14177 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 14178 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 14179 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 14180 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 14181 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 14182 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 14183 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 14184 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 14185 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 14186 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 14187 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 14188 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 14189 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 14190 14191 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 14192 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 14193 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 14194 } else { 14195 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 14196 I->getType()); 14197 } 14198 ++I; 14199 } 14200 } 14201 14202 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 14203 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 14204 if (!D) { 14205 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 14206 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 14207 PushFunctionScope(); 14208 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14209 return D; 14210 } 14211 14212 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 14213 14214 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14215 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 14216 else 14217 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 14218 14219 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 14220 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 14221 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 14222 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14223 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 14224 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 14225 14226 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 14227 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 14228 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 14229 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 14230 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14231 } 14232 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 14233 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 14234 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 14235 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14236 } 14237 14238 if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) { 14239 if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 14240 Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() && 14241 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 14242 // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any 14243 // default arguments. 14244 InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor); 14245 } 14246 } 14247 14248 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 14249 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 14250 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14251 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14252 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14253 14254 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14255 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14256 return D; 14257 } 14258 14259 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14260 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14261 // this function. 14262 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14263 14264 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14265 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14266 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14267 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14268 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14269 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14270 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14271 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14272 // have the LSI properly restored. 14273 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14274 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14275 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14276 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14277 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14278 } else { 14279 // Enter a new function scope 14280 PushFunctionScope(); 14281 } 14282 14283 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14284 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14285 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14286 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14287 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14288 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14289 } 14290 } 14291 14292 // The return type of a function definition must be complete 14293 // (C99 6.9.1p3, C++ [dcl.fct]p6). 14294 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14295 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14296 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 14297 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14298 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14299 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14300 14301 if (FnBodyScope) 14302 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14303 14304 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14305 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14306 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14307 14308 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14309 // scope. 14310 if (FnBodyScope) { 14311 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14312 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14313 if (!NonParmDecl) 14314 continue; 14315 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14316 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14317 14318 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14319 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14320 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14321 14322 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14323 // accessible in this scope. 14324 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14325 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14326 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14327 } 14328 } 14329 } 14330 14331 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14332 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14333 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14334 14335 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14336 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14337 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14338 14339 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14340 } 14341 } 14342 14343 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14344 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14345 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14346 14347 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14348 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14349 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14350 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14351 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14352 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14353 return D; 14354 } 14355 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14356 // a function template). 14357 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14358 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14359 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14360 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14361 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14362 14363 return D; 14364 } 14365 14366 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14367 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14368 /// optimization. 14369 /// 14370 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14371 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14372 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14373 /// use the named return value optimization. 14374 /// 14375 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14376 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14377 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14378 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14379 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14380 14381 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14382 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14383 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14384 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14385 } 14386 } 14387 } 14388 14389 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14390 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14391 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14392 return false; 14393 14394 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14395 // return type (yet). 14396 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14397 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14398 // we can still delay parsing it. 14399 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14400 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14401 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14402 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14403 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14404 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14405 } 14406 } 14407 return false; 14408 } 14409 14410 return true; 14411 } 14412 14413 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14414 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14415 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14416 // rest of the file. 14417 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14418 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14419 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14420 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14421 return false; 14422 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14423 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14424 // "undeduced". 14425 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14426 return false; 14427 } 14428 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14429 } 14430 14431 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14432 if (!Decl) 14433 return nullptr; 14434 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14435 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14436 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14437 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14438 return Decl; 14439 } 14440 14441 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14442 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14443 } 14444 14445 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14446 /// body. 14447 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14448 public: 14449 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14450 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14451 if (!IsLambda) 14452 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14453 } 14454 14455 private: 14456 Sema &S; 14457 bool IsLambda = false; 14458 }; 14459 14460 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14461 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14462 14463 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14464 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14465 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14466 14467 bool R = false; 14468 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14469 14470 do { 14471 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14472 if (R) 14473 break; 14474 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14475 } while (CurBD); 14476 14477 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14478 }; 14479 14480 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14481 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14482 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14483 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14484 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14485 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14486 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14487 } 14488 14489 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14490 bool IsInstantiation) { 14491 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14492 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14493 14494 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14495 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14496 14497 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14498 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 14499 14500 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 14501 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 14502 14503 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because one 14504 // is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). This is 14505 // meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 14506 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 14507 14508 if (FD) { 14509 FD->setBody(Body); 14510 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 14511 14512 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 14513 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 14514 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 14515 // If the function has a deduced result type but contains no 'return' 14516 // statements, the result type as written must be exactly 'auto', and 14517 // the deduced result type is 'void'. 14518 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 14519 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 14520 << FD->getReturnType(); 14521 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14522 } else { 14523 // Substitute 'void' for the 'auto' in the type. 14524 TypeLoc ResultType = getReturnTypeLoc(FD); 14525 Context.adjustDeducedFunctionResultType( 14526 FD, SubstAutoType(ResultType.getType(), Context.VoidTy)); 14527 } 14528 } 14529 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 14530 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 14531 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 14532 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 14533 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 14534 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 14535 14536 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 14537 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 14538 // [the deduced type is] the type void 14539 QualType RetType = 14540 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 14541 14542 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 14543 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14544 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 14545 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 14546 } 14547 } 14548 14549 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 14550 // don't complain about missing return statements. 14551 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14552 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 14553 14554 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 14555 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 14556 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 14557 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 14558 14559 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14560 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted or deleted functions. 14561 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody()) 14562 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 14563 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 14564 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 14565 14566 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 14567 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 14568 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 14569 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 14570 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 14571 14572 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 14573 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 14574 // to deduce an implicit return type. 14575 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 14576 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 14577 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14578 } 14579 14580 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 14581 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 14582 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 14583 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 14584 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 14585 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 14586 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 14587 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 14588 14589 if (PossiblePrototype) { 14590 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 14591 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 14592 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 14593 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14594 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 14595 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 14596 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 14597 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 14598 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 14599 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 14600 : FixItHint{}); 14601 } 14602 } else { 14603 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 14604 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 14605 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 14606 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 14607 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 14608 return false; 14609 14610 bool Invalid = false; 14611 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 14612 if (Invalid) 14613 return false; 14614 14615 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 14616 return false; 14617 14618 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 14619 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 14620 14621 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 14622 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 14623 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 14624 }; 14625 14626 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 14627 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 14628 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 14629 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 14630 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 14631 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 14632 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 14633 14634 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 14635 getLangOpts())) 14636 14637 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 14638 } 14639 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 14640 }; 14641 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 14642 << /* function */ 1 14643 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 14644 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 14645 : FixItHint{}); 14646 } 14647 14648 // GNU warning -Wstrict-prototypes 14649 // Warn if K&R function is defined without a previous declaration. 14650 // This warning is issued only if the definition itself does not provide 14651 // a prototype. Only K&R definitions do not provide a prototype. 14652 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 14653 TypeSourceInfo *TI = FD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 14654 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14655 FunctionTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAsAdjusted<FunctionTypeLoc>(); 14656 Diag(FTL.getLParenLoc(), diag::warn_strict_prototypes) << 2; 14657 } 14658 } 14659 14660 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 14661 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 14662 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 14663 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 14664 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 14665 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 14666 14667 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 14668 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 14669 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 14670 MD->isVirtual() && 14671 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 14672 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 14673 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 14674 if (FD->isInlined() && 14675 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 14676 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 14677 14678 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 14679 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 14680 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 14681 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 14682 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 14683 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 14684 } else { 14685 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 14686 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 14687 } 14688 } 14689 } 14690 14691 assert((FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 14692 "Function parsing confused"); 14693 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 14694 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 14695 MD->setBody(Body); 14696 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14697 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 14698 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 14699 14700 if (Body) 14701 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14702 } 14703 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 14704 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 14705 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 14706 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 14707 } 14708 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 14709 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 14710 bool isDesignated = 14711 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 14712 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 14713 (void)isDesignated; 14714 14715 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 14716 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 14717 if (!IFace) 14718 return false; 14719 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 14720 if (!SuperD) 14721 return false; 14722 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 14723 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 14724 }; 14725 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 14726 // of NSObject. 14727 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 14728 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 14729 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 14730 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 14731 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 14732 } 14733 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 14734 } 14735 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 14736 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 14737 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 14738 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 14739 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 14740 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 14741 } 14742 14743 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 14744 } else { 14745 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 14746 // we pushed on. 14747 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 14748 return nullptr; 14749 } 14750 14751 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 14752 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 14753 14754 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 14755 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 14756 "handled in the block above."); 14757 14758 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 14759 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 14760 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 14761 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 14762 // Verify this. 14763 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 14764 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 14765 14766 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 14767 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && 14768 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 14769 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 14770 14771 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 14772 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 14773 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 14774 14775 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 14776 Destructor->getParent()); 14777 } 14778 14779 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 14780 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 14781 // deletion in some later function. 14782 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 14783 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 14784 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 14785 } 14786 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && 14787 !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 14788 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 14789 // enabled. 14790 ActivePolicy = &WP; 14791 } 14792 14793 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 14794 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 14795 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14796 14797 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 14798 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 14799 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 14800 // require prologue. 14801 bool RegisterVariables = false; 14802 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 14803 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 14804 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 14805 RegisterVariables = 14806 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 14807 if (!RegisterVariables) 14808 break; 14809 } 14810 } 14811 } 14812 if (RegisterVariables) 14813 continue; 14814 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 14815 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 14816 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 14817 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14818 break; 14819 } 14820 } 14821 } 14822 14823 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 14824 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 14825 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 14826 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 14827 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 14828 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 14829 } 14830 14831 if (!IsInstantiation) 14832 PopDeclContext(); 14833 14834 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 14835 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 14836 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 14837 // deletion in some later function. 14838 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 14839 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 14840 } 14841 14842 if (FD && (LangOpts.OpenMP || LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) { 14843 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 14844 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 14845 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 14846 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD); 14847 } 14848 14849 return dcl; 14850 } 14851 14852 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 14853 /// relevant Decl. 14854 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 14855 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 14856 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 14857 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 14858 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 14859 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 14860 14861 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 14862 if (Method->isStatic()) 14863 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 14864 } 14865 14866 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 14867 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 14868 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 14869 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 14870 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 14871 // DeclContext. 14872 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 14873 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 14874 // instead. 14875 Scope *BlockScope = S; 14876 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 14877 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 14878 14879 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 14880 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 14881 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 14882 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 14883 14884 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 14885 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 14886 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 14887 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 14888 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 14889 if (ExternCPrev) { 14890 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 14891 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 14892 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 14893 14894 // C89 footnote 38: 14895 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 14896 // the behavior is undefined. 14897 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 14898 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 14899 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 14900 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 14901 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 14902 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 14903 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14904 return ExternCPrev; 14905 } 14906 } 14907 14908 // Extension in C99. Legal in C90, but warn about it. 14909 unsigned diag_id; 14910 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 14911 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 14912 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 14913 else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14914 diag_id = diag::err_opencl_implicit_function_decl; 14915 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 14916 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl; 14917 else 14918 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 14919 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 14920 14921 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 14922 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 14923 // more to do. 14924 if (ExternCPrev) 14925 return ExternCPrev; 14926 14927 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 14928 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 14929 if (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error) { 14930 TypoCorrection Corrected; 14931 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 14932 if (S && (Corrected = 14933 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 14934 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError))) 14935 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 14936 /*ErrorRecovery*/false); 14937 } 14938 14939 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 14940 const char *Dummy; 14941 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 14942 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 14943 unsigned DiagID; 14944 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 14945 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14946 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 14947 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 14948 SourceLocation NoLoc; 14949 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::Block); 14950 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 14951 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 14952 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 14953 /*Params=*/nullptr, 14954 /*NumParams=*/0, 14955 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 14956 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 14957 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 14958 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 14959 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 14960 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 14961 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 14962 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 14963 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 14964 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 14965 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 14966 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 14967 Loc, D), 14968 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 14969 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 14970 14971 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 14972 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 14973 FD->setImplicit(); 14974 14975 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 14976 14977 return FD; 14978 } 14979 14980 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 14981 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 14982 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 14983 /// 14984 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 14985 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 14986 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 14987 FunctionDecl *FD) { 14988 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14989 return; 14990 14991 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 14992 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 14993 return; 14994 14995 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 14996 bool IsNothrow = false; 14997 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 14998 return; 14999 15000 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 15001 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 15002 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 15003 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 15004 // throwing an exception [...] 15005 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 15006 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15007 15008 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15009 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15010 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 15011 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 15012 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 15013 // 15014 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 15015 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 15016 15017 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 15018 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 15019 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 15020 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 15021 // requested size. 15022 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 15023 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 15024 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 15025 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 15026 } 15027 15028 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15029 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15030 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15031 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 15032 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 15033 // specified by the value of this argument. 15034 if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 15035 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 15036 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 15037 } 15038 15039 // FIXME: 15040 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 15041 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 15042 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 15043 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 15044 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 15045 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 15046 // requested size. 15047 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 15048 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 15049 } 15050 15051 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 15052 /// the declaration of this function. 15053 /// 15054 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 15055 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 15056 /// like NSLog or printf. 15057 /// 15058 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 15059 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 15060 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 15061 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 15062 return; 15063 15064 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 15065 // actual attributes. 15066 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 15067 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 15068 unsigned FormatIdx; 15069 bool HasVAListArg; 15070 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 15071 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 15072 const char *fmt = "printf"; 15073 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 15074 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 15075 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 15076 fmt = "NSString"; 15077 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15078 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 15079 FormatIdx+1, 15080 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15081 FD->getLocation())); 15082 } 15083 } 15084 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 15085 HasVAListArg)) { 15086 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15087 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15088 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 15089 FormatIdx+1, 15090 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 15091 FD->getLocation())); 15092 } 15093 15094 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 15095 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 15096 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 15097 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 15098 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 15099 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 15100 15101 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 15102 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 15103 // intrinsics for such functions. 15104 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 15105 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 15106 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15107 15108 // We make "fma" on some platforms const because we know it does not set 15109 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 15110 // C standard. 15111 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 15112 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isAndroid() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 15113 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 15114 switch (BuiltinID) { 15115 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 15116 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 15117 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 15118 case Builtin::BIfma: 15119 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 15120 case Builtin::BIfmal: 15121 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15122 break; 15123 default: 15124 break; 15125 } 15126 } 15127 15128 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 15129 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 15130 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15131 FD->getLocation())); 15132 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 15133 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15134 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 15135 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15136 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 15137 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15138 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 15139 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 15140 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 15141 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 15142 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 15143 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 15144 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 15145 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15146 else 15147 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15148 } 15149 } 15150 15151 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 15152 15153 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 15154 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 15155 // across. 15156 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 15157 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 15158 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15159 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 15160 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 15161 } 15162 15163 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 15164 if (!Name) 15165 return; 15166 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15167 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 15168 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 15169 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 15170 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 15171 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 15172 // about. 15173 } else 15174 return; 15175 15176 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 15177 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 15178 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 15179 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 15180 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 15181 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 15182 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 15183 FD->getLocation())); 15184 } 15185 15186 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 15187 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 15188 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 15189 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 15190 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 15191 FD->getLocation())); 15192 } 15193 } 15194 15195 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 15196 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 15197 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 15198 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 15199 15200 if (!TInfo) { 15201 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 15202 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 15203 } 15204 15205 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 15206 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 15207 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 15208 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 15209 15210 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 15211 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 15212 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 15213 return NewTD; 15214 } 15215 15216 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 15217 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15218 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 15219 << 2 << NewTD 15220 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 15221 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 15222 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 15223 else 15224 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 15225 } 15226 15227 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 15228 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 15229 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 15230 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 15231 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 15232 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 15233 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 15234 case TST_enum: 15235 case TST_struct: 15236 case TST_interface: 15237 case TST_union: 15238 case TST_class: { 15239 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 15240 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 15241 break; 15242 } 15243 15244 default: 15245 break; 15246 } 15247 15248 return NewTD; 15249 } 15250 15251 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15252 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15253 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15254 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15255 15256 if (T->isDependentType()) 15257 return false; 15258 15259 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15260 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15261 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15262 if (BT->isInteger()) 15263 return false; 15264 15265 if (T->isExtIntType()) 15266 return false; 15267 15268 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15269 } 15270 15271 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15272 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15273 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15274 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15275 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15276 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15277 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15278 << Prev->isScoped(); 15279 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15280 return true; 15281 } 15282 15283 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15284 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15285 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15286 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15287 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15288 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15289 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15290 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15291 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15292 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15293 return true; 15294 } 15295 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15296 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15297 << Prev->isFixed(); 15298 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15299 return true; 15300 } 15301 15302 return false; 15303 } 15304 15305 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15306 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15307 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15308 /// 15309 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15310 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15311 switch (Tag) { 15312 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15313 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15314 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15315 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15316 } 15317 } 15318 15319 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15320 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15321 /// 15322 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15323 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15324 { 15325 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15326 } 15327 15328 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15329 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15330 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15331 return NTK_Typedef; 15332 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15333 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15334 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15335 return NTK_Template; 15336 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15337 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15338 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15339 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15340 switch (TTK) { 15341 case TTK_Struct: 15342 case TTK_Interface: 15343 case TTK_Class: 15344 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15345 case TTK_Union: 15346 return NTK_NonUnion; 15347 case TTK_Enum: 15348 return NTK_NonEnum; 15349 } 15350 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15351 } 15352 15353 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15354 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15355 /// 15356 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15357 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15358 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15359 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15360 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15361 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15362 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15363 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15364 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15365 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15366 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15367 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15368 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15369 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15370 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15371 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15372 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15373 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15374 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15375 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15376 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15377 return false; 15378 15379 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15380 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15381 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15382 return true; 15383 15384 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15385 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15386 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15387 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15388 // declarations. 15389 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15390 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15391 Loc); 15392 }; 15393 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15394 return true; 15395 15396 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15397 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 15398 }; 15399 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 15400 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 15401 if (!Previous) 15402 return true; 15403 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15404 } 15405 15406 bool isTemplate = false; 15407 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 15408 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 15409 15410 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 15411 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 15412 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 15413 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 15414 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15415 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15416 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15417 // FIXME: Note previous location? 15418 } 15419 return true; 15420 } 15421 15422 if (isDefinition) { 15423 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 15424 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 15425 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 15426 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 15427 return true; 15428 } 15429 15430 bool previousMismatch = false; 15431 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 15432 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15433 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 15434 if (IsIgnored(I)) 15435 continue; 15436 15437 if (!previousMismatch) { 15438 previousMismatch = true; 15439 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 15440 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15441 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 15442 } 15443 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15444 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 15445 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 15446 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 15447 } 15448 } 15449 return true; 15450 } 15451 15452 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 15453 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 15454 // (non-ignored) declaration. 15455 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 15456 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 15457 PrevDef = nullptr; 15458 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 15459 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15460 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15461 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15462 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15463 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15464 15465 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 15466 if (PrevDef) { 15467 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15468 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 15469 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 15470 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 15471 } 15472 } 15473 15474 return true; 15475 } 15476 15477 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 15478 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 15479 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 15480 /// namespace N { 15481 /// struct X; 15482 /// namespace M { 15483 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 15484 /// } 15485 /// } 15486 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 15487 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 15488 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 15489 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 15490 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 15491 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 15492 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15493 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 15494 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 15495 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 15496 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 15497 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 15498 return FixItHint(); 15499 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 15500 Namespaces.push_back(II); 15501 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 15502 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 15503 if (Lookup == Namespace) 15504 break; 15505 } 15506 15507 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 15508 // build an NNS. 15509 SmallString<64> Insertion; 15510 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 15511 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 15512 OS << "::"; 15513 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 15514 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 15515 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 15516 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 15517 } 15518 15519 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 15520 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 15521 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 15522 /// using-declaration). 15523 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 15524 DeclContext *NewDC) { 15525 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 15526 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 15527 15528 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 15529 return true; 15530 15531 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 15532 // encloses the other). 15533 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 15534 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 15535 return true; 15536 15537 return false; 15538 } 15539 15540 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 15541 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 15542 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 15543 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 15544 /// 15545 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 15546 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 15547 /// 15548 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 15549 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 15550 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 15551 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 15552 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 15553 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 15554 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 15555 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 15556 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 15557 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 15558 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 15559 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 15560 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 15561 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 15562 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 15563 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 15564 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 15565 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 15566 15567 OwnedDecl = false; 15568 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 15569 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 15570 15571 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 15572 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 15573 bool Invalid = false; 15574 15575 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 15576 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 15577 // for non-C++ cases. 15578 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 15579 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 15580 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 15581 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 15582 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 15583 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 15584 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15585 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 15586 return nullptr; 15587 } 15588 15589 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 15590 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 15591 // be a member of another template). 15592 15593 if (Invalid) 15594 return nullptr; 15595 15596 OwnedDecl = false; 15597 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 15598 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 15599 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 15600 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 15601 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 15602 return Result.get(); 15603 } else { 15604 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 15605 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 15606 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 15607 isMemberSpecialization = true; 15608 } 15609 } 15610 15611 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 15612 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 15613 return nullptr; 15614 } 15615 15616 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 15617 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 15618 // redeclaration. 15619 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 15620 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 15621 15622 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15623 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 15624 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 15625 // type, default to int. 15626 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15627 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 15628 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 15629 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 15630 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 15631 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 15632 EnumUnderlying = TI; 15633 15634 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 15635 // Recover by falling back to int. 15636 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15637 15638 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 15639 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 15640 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15641 15642 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 15643 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 15644 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 15645 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 15646 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 15647 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 15648 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15649 } 15650 } 15651 15652 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 15653 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 15654 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 15655 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 15656 15657 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 15658 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 15659 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 15660 15661 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 15662 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 15663 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 15664 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 15665 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 15666 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 15667 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 15668 // keyword. 15669 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 15670 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 15671 15672 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15673 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 15674 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 15675 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 15676 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 15677 return nullptr; 15678 if (EnumUnderlying) { 15679 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 15680 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 15681 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 15682 else 15683 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 15684 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 15685 } 15686 } else { // struct/union 15687 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 15688 nullptr); 15689 } 15690 15691 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 15692 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 15693 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 15694 // 15695 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 15696 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 15697 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 15698 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 15699 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 15700 // parsing of the struct). 15701 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 15702 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 15703 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 15704 } 15705 } 15706 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 15707 return New; 15708 }; 15709 15710 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 15711 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 15712 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 15713 15714 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 15715 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 15716 Name = nullptr; 15717 goto CreateNewDecl; 15718 } 15719 15720 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 15721 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 15722 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 15723 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 15724 if (!DC) { 15725 IsDependent = true; 15726 return nullptr; 15727 } 15728 } else { 15729 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 15730 if (!DC) { 15731 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 15732 << SS.getRange(); 15733 return nullptr; 15734 } 15735 } 15736 15737 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 15738 return nullptr; 15739 15740 SearchDC = DC; 15741 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 15742 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 15743 15744 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 15745 return nullptr; 15746 15747 if (Previous.empty()) { 15748 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 15749 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 15750 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 15751 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 15752 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 15753 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 15754 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 15755 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 15756 IsDependent = true; 15757 return nullptr; 15758 } 15759 15760 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 15761 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 15762 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 15763 Name = nullptr; 15764 Invalid = true; 15765 goto CreateNewDecl; 15766 } 15767 } else if (Name) { 15768 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 15769 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 15770 // name different from T: 15771 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 15772 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 15773 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 15774 return nullptr; 15775 15776 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 15777 // declaration or definition. 15778 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 15779 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 15780 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 15781 LookupName(Previous, S); 15782 15783 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 15784 // by types using'ed into this scope. 15785 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 15786 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 15787 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 15788 while (F.hasNext()) { 15789 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 15790 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 15791 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 15792 F.erase(); 15793 } 15794 F.done(); 15795 } 15796 15797 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 15798 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 15799 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 15800 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 15801 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 15802 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 15803 // 15804 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 15805 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 15806 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 15807 // 15808 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 15809 // semantic context? 15810 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 15811 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 15812 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 15813 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 15814 while (F.hasNext()) { 15815 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 15816 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15817 if (DC->isFileContext() && 15818 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 15819 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 15820 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 15821 else 15822 F.erase(); 15823 } 15824 } 15825 F.done(); 15826 15827 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 15828 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 15829 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 15830 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 15831 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 15832 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 15833 } 15834 } 15835 15836 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 15837 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 15838 return nullptr; 15839 15840 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 15841 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 15842 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 15843 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 15844 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 15845 while (isa<RecordDecl>(SearchDC) || isa<EnumDecl>(SearchDC)) 15846 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 15847 } 15848 } 15849 15850 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 15851 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 15852 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 15853 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 15854 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 15855 Previous.clear(); 15856 } 15857 15858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 15859 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 15860 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 15861 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 15862 isStdBadAlloc = true; 15863 15864 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 15865 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 15866 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 15867 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 15868 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 15869 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 15870 isStdAlignValT = true; 15871 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 15872 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 15873 } 15874 } 15875 15876 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 15877 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 15878 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 15879 // there's a shadow friend decl. 15880 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 15881 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 15882 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 15883 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 15884 15885 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 15886 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 15887 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 15888 // 15889 // class-key identifier 15890 // 15891 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 15892 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 15893 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 15894 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 15895 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 15896 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 15897 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 15898 // declaration. 15899 // 15900 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 15901 // C structs and unions. 15902 // 15903 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 15904 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 15905 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 15906 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 15907 // 15908 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 15909 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 15910 // 15911 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 15912 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 15913 // lexical context, 15914 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 15915 15916 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 15917 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 15918 } else { 15919 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 15920 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 15921 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 15922 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 15923 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 15924 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 15925 } 15926 15927 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 15928 // diagnose some problems. 15929 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 15930 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 15931 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 15932 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 15933 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 15934 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 15935 // which are meaningless. 15936 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 15937 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 15938 } else { 15939 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 15940 LookupName(Previous, S); 15941 } 15942 } 15943 15944 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 15945 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 15946 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 15947 15948 if (!Previous.empty()) { 15949 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 15950 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 15951 15952 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 15953 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 15954 // insanity with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen 15955 // in C++. 15956 // 15957 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 15958 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 15959 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 15960 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 15961 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 15962 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 15963 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 15964 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 15965 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 15966 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 15967 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 15968 PrevDecl = Tag; 15969 Previous.clear(); 15970 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 15971 Previous.resolveKind(); 15972 } 15973 } 15974 } 15975 } 15976 15977 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 15978 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 15979 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 15980 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 15981 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 15982 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 15983 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 15984 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 15985 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 15986 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 15987 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 15988 diag::note_using_decl_target); 15989 Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 15990 << 0; 15991 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 15992 Previous.clear(); 15993 goto CreateNewDecl; 15994 } 15995 } 15996 15997 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 15998 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 15999 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 16000 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 16001 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 16002 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16003 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16004 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 16005 // struct or something similar. 16006 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 16007 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 16008 Name)) { 16009 bool SafeToContinue 16010 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 16011 Kind != TTK_Enum); 16012 if (SafeToContinue) 16013 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 16014 << Name 16015 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 16016 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 16017 else 16018 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 16019 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 16020 16021 if (SafeToContinue) 16022 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 16023 else { 16024 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 16025 Name = nullptr; 16026 Previous.clear(); 16027 Invalid = true; 16028 } 16029 } 16030 16031 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 16032 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 16033 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 16034 return PrevTagDecl; 16035 16036 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 16037 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16038 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 16039 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 16040 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 16041 16042 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 16043 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 16044 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 16045 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 16046 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 16047 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 16048 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 16049 } 16050 16051 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 16052 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 16053 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 16054 // and then later defined. 16055 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 16056 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 16057 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 16058 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16059 } 16060 16061 if (!Invalid) { 16062 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 16063 // we have attributes. 16064 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16065 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 16066 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 16067 // declaration to hold them. 16068 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 16069 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 16070 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 16071 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 16072 SS.isEmpty()) { 16073 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 16074 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 16075 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 16076 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 16077 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 16078 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 16079 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 16080 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 16081 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 16082 return PrevTagDecl; 16083 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 16084 // that scope. 16085 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 16086 } else { 16087 return PrevTagDecl; 16088 } 16089 } 16090 16091 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 16092 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16093 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 16094 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 16095 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 16096 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 16097 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 16098 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 16099 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 16100 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16101 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16102 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16103 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 16104 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 16105 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 16106 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 16107 } 16108 16109 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 16110 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 16111 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 16112 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 16113 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 16114 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 16115 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 16116 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 16117 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 16118 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 16119 // use it in place of this one. 16120 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16121 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 16122 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 16123 // comparison. 16124 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 16125 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 16126 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16127 return Def; 16128 } else { 16129 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 16130 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 16131 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 16132 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 16133 // skip starting the definitiion later. 16134 } 16135 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 16136 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 16137 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 16138 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 16139 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 16140 else 16141 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 16142 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 16143 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 16144 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 16145 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 16146 // references get the previous definition. 16147 Name = nullptr; 16148 Previous.clear(); 16149 Invalid = true; 16150 } 16151 } else { 16152 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 16153 // about a nested redefinition. 16154 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 16155 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 16156 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 16157 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 16158 diag::note_previous_definition); 16159 Name = nullptr; 16160 Previous.clear(); 16161 Invalid = true; 16162 } 16163 } 16164 16165 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 16166 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 16167 } 16168 16169 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 16170 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 16171 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 16172 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 16173 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 16174 AS = AS_none; 16175 } 16176 } 16177 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 16178 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 16179 16180 } else { 16181 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 16182 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 16183 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 16184 // have distinct types. 16185 Previous.clear(); 16186 } 16187 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 16188 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 16189 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 16190 16191 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 16192 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 16193 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 16194 } else { 16195 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 16196 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 16197 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 16198 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 16199 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 16200 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16201 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 16202 << Kind; 16203 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 16204 Invalid = true; 16205 16206 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 16207 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 16208 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 16209 // do nothing 16210 16211 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 16212 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16213 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 16214 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 16215 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16216 Invalid = true; 16217 16218 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 16219 // case here. 16220 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16221 unsigned Kind = 0; 16222 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 16223 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 16224 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 16225 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 16226 Invalid = true; 16227 16228 // Otherwise, diagnose. 16229 } else { 16230 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 16231 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 16232 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 16233 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 16234 Name = nullptr; 16235 Invalid = true; 16236 } 16237 16238 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 16239 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 16240 Previous.clear(); 16241 } 16242 } 16243 16244 CreateNewDecl: 16245 16246 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16247 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 16248 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 16249 16250 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16251 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16252 // keyword. 16253 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16254 16255 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16256 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16257 // PrevDecl. 16258 TagDecl *New; 16259 16260 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16261 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16262 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16263 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16264 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16265 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16266 16267 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16268 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16269 16270 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16271 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16272 TagDecl *Def; 16273 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16274 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16275 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16276 } 16277 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16278 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16279 << New; 16280 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16281 } else { 16282 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16283 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16284 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16285 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16286 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16287 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16288 } 16289 } 16290 16291 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16292 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16293 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16294 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16295 else 16296 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 16297 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16298 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16299 } 16300 } else { 16301 // struct/union/class 16302 16303 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16304 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16305 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16306 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16307 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16308 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16309 16310 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16311 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16312 } else 16313 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16314 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16315 } 16316 16317 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16318 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16319 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16320 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16321 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16322 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16323 Invalid = true; 16324 } 16325 16326 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16327 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16328 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16329 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16330 Invalid = true; 16331 } 16332 16333 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16334 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16335 if (SS.isSet()) { 16336 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16337 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16338 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16339 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16340 isMemberSpecialization)) 16341 Invalid = true; 16342 16343 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16344 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16345 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16346 } 16347 } 16348 else 16349 Invalid = true; 16350 } 16351 16352 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16353 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16354 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16355 // 16356 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16357 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16358 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16359 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16360 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16361 // parsing of the struct). 16362 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16363 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16364 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16365 } 16366 } 16367 16368 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16369 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16370 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16371 << 2 16372 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16373 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16374 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16375 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16376 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16377 New->setModulePrivate(); 16378 } 16379 16380 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16381 // check the specialization. 16382 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 16383 Invalid = true; 16384 16385 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 16386 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 16387 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 16388 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 16389 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 16390 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16391 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 16392 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 16393 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 16394 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 16395 << Name; 16396 Invalid = true; 16397 } 16398 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 16399 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16400 } 16401 } 16402 16403 if (Invalid) 16404 New->setInvalidDecl(); 16405 16406 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 16407 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 16408 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16409 16410 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 16411 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 16412 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 16413 // the tag name visible. 16414 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 16415 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 16416 16417 // Set the access specifier. 16418 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 16419 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 16420 16421 if (PrevDecl) 16422 CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, PrevDecl); 16423 16424 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 16425 New->startDefinition(); 16426 16427 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 16428 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 16429 16430 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 16431 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16432 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 16433 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 16434 if (PrevDecl) 16435 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 16436 16437 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16438 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 16439 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 16440 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 16441 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 16442 } else if (Name) { 16443 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 16444 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 16445 } else { 16446 CurContext->addDecl(New); 16447 } 16448 16449 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 16450 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 16451 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 16452 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 16453 II->isStr("FILE")) 16454 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 16455 16456 if (PrevDecl) 16457 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 16458 16459 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 16460 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 16461 16462 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16463 // record. 16464 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 16465 16466 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 16467 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 16468 16469 OwnedDecl = true; 16470 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 16471 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 16472 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16473 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 16474 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 16475 RD->completeDefinition(); 16476 return nullptr; 16477 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 16478 return SkipBody->Previous; 16479 } else { 16480 return New; 16481 } 16482 } 16483 16484 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16485 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16486 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16487 16488 // Enter the tag context. 16489 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 16490 16491 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 16492 16493 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16494 // record. 16495 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 16496 } 16497 16498 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(DeclSpec &DS, Decl *Prev, 16499 SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 16500 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 16501 return false; 16502 16503 // Make the previous decl visible. 16504 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 16505 return true; 16506 } 16507 16508 Decl *Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(Decl *IDecl) { 16509 assert(isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(IDecl) && 16510 "ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition - Not ObjCContainerDecl"); 16511 DeclContext *OCD = cast<DeclContext>(IDecl); 16512 assert(OCD->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 16513 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 16514 CurContext = OCD; 16515 return IDecl; 16516 } 16517 16518 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16519 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 16520 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 16521 bool IsAbstract, 16522 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 16523 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16524 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 16525 16526 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 16527 16528 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 16529 return; 16530 16531 if (IsAbstract) 16532 Record->markAbstract(); 16533 16534 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) { 16535 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 16536 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 16537 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 16538 } 16539 // C++ [class]p2: 16540 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 16541 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 16542 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 16543 // as if it were a public member name. 16544 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 16545 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 16546 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 16547 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 16548 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 16549 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 16550 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 16551 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 16552 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 16553 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 16554 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 16555 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 16556 "Broken injected-class-name"); 16557 } 16558 16559 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16560 SourceRange BraceRange) { 16561 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16562 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16563 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 16564 16565 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 16566 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 16567 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 16568 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 16569 RD->completeDefinition(); 16570 } 16571 16572 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 16573 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 16574 } 16575 16576 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 16577 PopDeclContext(); 16578 16579 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 16580 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 16581 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 16582 16583 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 16584 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 16585 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 16586 } 16587 16588 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 16589 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 16590 PopDeclContext(); 16591 } 16592 16593 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 16594 assert(DC == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 16595 OriginalLexicalContext = DC; 16596 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 16597 } 16598 16599 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 16600 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(cast<Decl>(DC)); 16601 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 16602 } 16603 16604 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16605 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16606 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16607 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 16608 16609 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 16610 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 16611 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 16612 RD->completeDefinition(); 16613 } 16614 16615 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 16616 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 16617 // the FieldCollector. 16618 16619 PopDeclContext(); 16620 } 16621 16622 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 16623 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 16624 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, 16625 QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct, 16626 Expr *BitWidth, bool *ZeroWidth) { 16627 assert(BitWidth); 16628 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 16629 return ExprError(); 16630 16631 // Default to true; that shouldn't confuse checks for emptiness 16632 if (ZeroWidth) 16633 *ZeroWidth = true; 16634 16635 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 16636 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 16637 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 16638 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 16639 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 16640 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 16641 return ExprError(); 16642 if (FieldName) 16643 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 16644 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 16645 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 16646 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 16647 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 16648 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 16649 return ExprError(); 16650 16651 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 16652 // it now. 16653 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 16654 return BitWidth; 16655 16656 llvm::APSInt Value; 16657 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 16658 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 16659 return ICE; 16660 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 16661 16662 if (Value != 0 && ZeroWidth) 16663 *ZeroWidth = false; 16664 16665 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 16666 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 16667 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 16668 16669 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 16670 if (FieldName) 16671 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 16672 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 16673 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 16674 << toString(Value, 10); 16675 } 16676 16677 // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object 16678 // size. 16679 if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 16680 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide) 16681 << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10); 16682 } 16683 16684 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 16685 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 16686 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 16687 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 16688 16689 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 16690 // ABI. 16691 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 16692 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 16693 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 16694 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 16695 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 16696 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 16697 unsigned DiagWidth = 16698 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 16699 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16700 << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 16701 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 16702 } 16703 16704 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 16705 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 16706 // 'bool'. 16707 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) { 16708 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16709 << FieldName << toString(Value, 10) 16710 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 16711 } 16712 } 16713 16714 return BitWidth; 16715 } 16716 16717 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 16718 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 16719 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 16720 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 16721 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 16722 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 16723 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 16724 return Res; 16725 } 16726 16727 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 16728 /// 16729 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 16730 SourceLocation DeclStart, 16731 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 16732 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 16733 AccessSpecifier AS) { 16734 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 16735 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 16736 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 16737 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 16738 return nullptr; 16739 } 16740 16741 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 16742 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 16743 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 16744 16745 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 16746 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 16747 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16748 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 16749 16750 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 16751 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 16752 D.setInvalidType(); 16753 T = Context.IntTy; 16754 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 16755 } 16756 } 16757 16758 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 16759 16760 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 16761 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 16762 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 16763 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 16764 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 16765 diag::err_invalid_thread) 16766 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 16767 16768 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 16769 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16770 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 16771 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 16772 LookupName(Previous, S); 16773 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 16774 case LookupResult::Found: 16775 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 16776 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 16777 break; 16778 16779 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 16780 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16781 break; 16782 16783 case LookupResult::NotFound: 16784 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 16785 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 16786 break; 16787 } 16788 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 16789 16790 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 16791 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16792 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 16793 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16794 PrevDecl = nullptr; 16795 } 16796 16797 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 16798 PrevDecl = nullptr; 16799 16800 bool Mutable 16801 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 16802 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 16803 FieldDecl *NewFD 16804 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 16805 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 16806 16807 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 16808 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16809 16810 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 16811 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 16812 16813 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 16814 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 16815 // with the same name in the same scope. 16816 } else if (II) { 16817 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 16818 } else 16819 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 16820 16821 return NewFD; 16822 } 16823 16824 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 16825 /// 16826 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 16827 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 16828 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 16829 /// created. 16830 /// 16831 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 16832 /// 16833 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 16834 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 16835 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 16836 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 16837 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 16838 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 16839 SourceLocation TSSL, 16840 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 16841 Declarator *D) { 16842 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 16843 bool InvalidDecl = false; 16844 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 16845 16846 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 16847 // marking this declaration as invalid. 16848 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 16849 InvalidDecl = true; 16850 T = Context.IntTy; 16851 } 16852 16853 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 16854 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 16855 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 16856 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 16857 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 16858 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16859 InvalidDecl = true; 16860 } else { 16861 NamedDecl *Def; 16862 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 16863 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 16864 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16865 InvalidDecl = true; 16866 } 16867 } 16868 } 16869 16870 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 16871 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 16872 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 16873 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 16874 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16875 InvalidDecl = true; 16876 } 16877 16878 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 16879 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 16880 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 16881 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 16882 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 16883 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 16884 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16885 InvalidDecl = true; 16886 } 16887 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension 16888 // is enabled. 16889 if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( 16890 "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) { 16891 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 16892 InvalidDecl = true; 16893 } 16894 } 16895 16896 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 16897 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 16898 T.hasQualifiers()) { 16899 InvalidDecl = true; 16900 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 16901 } 16902 16903 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 16904 // than a variably modified type. 16905 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 16906 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 16907 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size)) 16908 InvalidDecl = true; 16909 } 16910 16911 // Fields can not have abstract class types 16912 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 16913 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 16914 AbstractFieldType)) 16915 InvalidDecl = true; 16916 16917 bool ZeroWidth = false; 16918 if (InvalidDecl) 16919 BitWidth = nullptr; 16920 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 16921 if (BitWidth) { 16922 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth, 16923 &ZeroWidth).get(); 16924 if (!BitWidth) { 16925 InvalidDecl = true; 16926 BitWidth = nullptr; 16927 ZeroWidth = false; 16928 } 16929 } 16930 16931 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 16932 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 16933 unsigned DiagID = 0; 16934 if (T->isReferenceType()) 16935 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 16936 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 16937 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 16938 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 16939 16940 if (DiagID) { 16941 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 16942 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 16943 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 16944 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 16945 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 16946 Mutable = false; 16947 InvalidDecl = true; 16948 } 16949 } 16950 } 16951 16952 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 16953 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 16954 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 16955 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 16956 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 16957 16958 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 16959 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 16960 if (InvalidDecl) 16961 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16962 16963 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16964 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 16965 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16966 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16967 } 16968 16969 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16970 if (Record->isUnion()) { 16971 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 16972 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 16973 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 16974 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 16975 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 16976 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 16977 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 16978 // objects. 16979 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 16980 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16981 } 16982 } 16983 16984 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 16985 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 16986 // enabled. 16987 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 16988 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 16989 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 16990 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 16991 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 16992 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 16993 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16994 } 16995 } 16996 } 16997 16998 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 16999 // representation, not a parser representation. 17000 if (D) { 17001 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 17002 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 17003 17004 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 17005 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 17006 } 17007 17008 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 17009 // retainable type. 17010 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 17011 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17012 17013 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 17014 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 17015 17016 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 17017 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 17018 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 17019 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 17020 17021 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 17022 return NewFD; 17023 } 17024 17025 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 17026 assert(FD); 17027 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 17028 17029 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 17030 return false; 17031 17032 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17033 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17034 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 17035 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 17036 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 17037 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 17038 // copy constructors. 17039 17040 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 17041 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 17042 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 17043 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 17044 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 17045 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 17046 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 17047 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 17048 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 17049 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 17050 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 17051 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 17052 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 17053 member = CXXDestructor; 17054 17055 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 17056 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 17057 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 17058 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 17059 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 17060 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 17061 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 17062 // members unavailable. 17063 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17064 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 17065 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 17066 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 17067 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 17068 return false; 17069 } 17070 } 17071 17072 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 17073 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 17074 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 17075 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 17076 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 17077 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 17078 } 17079 } 17080 } 17081 17082 return false; 17083 } 17084 17085 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 17086 /// AST enum value. 17087 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 17088 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 17089 switch (ivarVisibility) { 17090 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 17091 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 17092 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 17093 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 17094 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 17095 } 17096 } 17097 17098 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 17099 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 17100 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 17101 SourceLocation DeclStart, 17102 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 17103 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 17104 17105 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 17106 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 17107 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 17108 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 17109 17110 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 17111 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 17112 17113 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 17114 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 17115 17116 if (BitWidth) { 17117 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 17118 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 17119 if (!BitWidth) 17120 D.setInvalidType(); 17121 } else { 17122 // Not a bitfield. 17123 17124 // validate II. 17125 17126 } 17127 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 17128 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 17129 D.setInvalidType(); 17130 } 17131 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 17132 // than a variably modified type. 17133 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 17134 if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType( 17135 TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size)) 17136 D.setInvalidType(); 17137 } 17138 17139 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 17140 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 17141 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 17142 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 17143 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 17144 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 17145 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 17146 return nullptr; 17147 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 17148 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17149 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17150 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 17151 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 17152 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 17153 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 17154 } 17155 else 17156 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17157 } else { 17158 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17159 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17160 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 17161 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 17162 return nullptr; 17163 } 17164 } 17165 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 17166 } 17167 17168 // Construct the decl. 17169 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 17170 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 17171 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 17172 17173 if (II) { 17174 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 17175 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17176 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 17177 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17178 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 17179 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 17180 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17181 } 17182 } 17183 17184 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 17185 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 17186 17187 if (D.isInvalidType()) 17188 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17189 17190 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 17191 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 17192 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 17193 17194 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 17195 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 17196 17197 if (II) { 17198 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 17199 // these to the interface. 17200 S->AddDecl(NewID); 17201 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 17202 } 17203 17204 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 17205 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 17206 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 17207 17208 return NewID; 17209 } 17210 17211 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 17212 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 17213 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 17214 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 17215 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 17216 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 17217 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 17218 return; 17219 17220 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 17221 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 17222 17223 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17224 return; 17225 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 17226 if (!ID) { 17227 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 17228 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 17229 return; 17230 } 17231 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 17232 else 17233 return; 17234 } 17235 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 17236 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 17237 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17238 17239 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17240 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17241 Context.CharTy, 17242 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17243 DeclLoc), 17244 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17245 true); 17246 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17247 } 17248 17249 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17250 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17251 SourceLocation RBrac, 17252 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17253 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17254 17255 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17256 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17257 // it will now change. 17258 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17259 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17260 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17261 default: break; 17262 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17263 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17264 break; 17265 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17266 Context. 17267 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17268 break; 17269 } 17270 } 17271 17272 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17273 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17274 17275 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17276 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17277 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17278 if (Record) { 17279 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17280 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17281 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17282 ++NumNamedMembers; 17283 } 17284 } 17285 17286 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17287 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17288 17289 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17290 i != end; ++i) { 17291 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17292 17293 // Get the type for the field. 17294 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 17295 17296 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 17297 // Remember all fields written by the user. 17298 RecFields.push_back(FD); 17299 } 17300 17301 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 17302 // diagnostics about it. 17303 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 17304 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17305 continue; 17306 } 17307 17308 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 17309 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 17310 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 17311 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 17312 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 17313 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 17314 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 17315 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 17316 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 17317 // array. 17318 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 17319 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 17320 // Field declared as a function. 17321 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 17322 << FD->getDeclName(); 17323 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17324 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17325 continue; 17326 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 17327 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 17328 if (Record) { 17329 // Flexible array member. 17330 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 17331 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 17332 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 17333 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17334 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 17335 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 17336 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 17337 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 17338 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17339 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17340 continue; 17341 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 17342 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17343 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 17344 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17345 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 17346 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 17347 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 17348 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17349 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 17350 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17351 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 17352 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 17353 17354 if (DiagID) 17355 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 17356 << Record->getTagKind(); 17357 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 17358 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 17359 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 17360 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 17361 // of the type. 17362 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 17363 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 17364 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17365 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 17366 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 17367 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17368 17369 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 17370 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 17371 // 17372 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 17373 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 17374 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17375 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 17376 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 17377 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17378 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17379 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17380 continue; 17381 } 17382 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 17383 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17384 } else { 17385 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 17386 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 17387 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 17388 } 17389 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 17390 RequireCompleteSizedType( 17391 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17392 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17393 // Incomplete type 17394 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17395 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17396 continue; 17397 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17398 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 17399 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 17400 // flexible array member. 17401 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17402 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 17403 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 17404 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 17405 // structures. 17406 if (!IsLastField) 17407 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 17408 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17409 else { 17410 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 17411 // other structs as an extension. 17412 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 17413 << FD->getDeclName(); 17414 } 17415 } 17416 } 17417 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 17418 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17419 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17420 AbstractIvarType)) { 17421 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 17422 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17423 } 17424 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17425 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17426 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 17427 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17428 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 17429 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 17430 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 17431 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 17432 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 17433 FD->setType(T); 17434 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 17435 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 17436 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 17437 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 17438 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 17439 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 17440 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 17441 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 17442 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 17443 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 17444 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 17445 // ARC. 17446 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 17447 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 17448 FD->getLocation())); 17449 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 17450 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 17451 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 17452 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17453 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 17454 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17455 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 17456 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17457 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 17458 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17459 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17460 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17461 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 17462 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17463 } 17464 } 17465 17466 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17467 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 17468 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 17469 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 17470 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 17471 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 17472 Record->isUnion()) 17473 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 17474 } 17475 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 17476 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 17477 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 17478 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17479 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 17480 } 17481 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 17482 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 17483 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 17484 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17485 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 17486 } 17487 17488 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17489 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 17490 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 17491 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17492 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 17493 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17494 } 17495 17496 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 17497 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17498 // Keep track of the number of named members. 17499 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 17500 ++NumNamedMembers; 17501 } 17502 17503 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 17504 if (Record) { 17505 bool Completed = false; 17506 if (CXXRecord) { 17507 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17508 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 17509 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 17510 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 17511 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 17512 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 17513 } 17514 17515 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 17516 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 17517 17518 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 17519 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17520 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 17521 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 17522 // problem now. 17523 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 17524 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 17525 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 17526 17527 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 17528 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 17529 M != MEnd; ++M) { 17530 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 17531 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 17532 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 17533 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 17534 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 17535 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 17536 continue; 17537 17538 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 17539 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 17540 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 17541 // program is ill-formed. 17542 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 17543 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 17544 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 17545 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 17546 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 17547 OM = SO->second.begin(), 17548 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 17549 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 17550 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 17551 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 17552 17553 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17554 } 17555 } 17556 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 17557 Completed = true; 17558 } 17559 } 17560 } 17561 } 17562 17563 if (!Completed) 17564 Record->completeDefinition(); 17565 17566 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 17567 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 17568 17569 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 17570 if (CXXRecord) { 17571 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 17572 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 17573 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 17574 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 17575 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 17576 } 17577 } 17578 17579 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 17580 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 17581 17582 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 17583 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 17584 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 17585 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 17586 } 17587 17588 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 17589 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 17590 // compatibility problems. 17591 bool CheckForZeroSize; 17592 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17593 CheckForZeroSize = true; 17594 } else { 17595 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 17596 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 17597 CheckForZeroSize = 17598 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 17599 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 17600 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 17601 } 17602 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 17603 bool ZeroSize = true; 17604 bool IsEmpty = true; 17605 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 17606 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 17607 E = Record->field_end(); 17608 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 17609 IsEmpty = false; 17610 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 17611 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17612 ZeroSize = false; 17613 } else { 17614 ++NonBitFields; 17615 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 17616 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 17617 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 17618 ZeroSize = false; 17619 } 17620 } 17621 17622 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 17623 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 17624 // extern "C" block. 17625 if (ZeroSize) { 17626 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 17627 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 17628 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 17629 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 17630 } 17631 17632 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 17633 // but are accepted by GCC. 17634 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17635 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 17636 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 17637 << Record->isUnion(); 17638 } 17639 } 17640 } else { 17641 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 17642 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 17643 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17644 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 17645 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 17646 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 17647 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 17648 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 17649 } 17650 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 17651 // duplicates. 17652 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 17653 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 17654 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17655 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17656 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 17657 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 17658 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 17659 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 17660 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 17661 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 17662 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 17663 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 17664 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17665 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17666 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 17667 // reported as errors elsewhere. 17668 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 17669 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 17670 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 17671 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 17672 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 17673 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 17674 if (IDecl) { 17675 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 17676 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 17677 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 17678 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 17679 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 17680 continue; 17681 } 17682 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 17683 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 17684 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 17685 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 17686 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 17687 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 17688 continue; 17689 } 17690 } 17691 } 17692 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 17693 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 17694 } 17695 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 17696 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 17697 } 17698 } 17699 } 17700 17701 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 17702 /// the given type T. 17703 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 17704 llvm::APSInt &Value, 17705 QualType T) { 17706 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 17707 "Integral type required!"); 17708 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 17709 17710 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 17711 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 17712 --BitWidth; 17713 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 17714 } 17715 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 17716 } 17717 17718 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 17719 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 17720 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 17721 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 17722 // enum checking below. 17723 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 17724 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 17725 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 17726 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 17727 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 17728 }; 17729 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 17730 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 17731 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 17732 }; 17733 17734 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 17735 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 17736 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 17737 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 17738 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 17739 return Types[I]; 17740 17741 return QualType(); 17742 } 17743 17744 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 17745 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 17746 SourceLocation IdLoc, 17747 IdentifierInfo *Id, 17748 Expr *Val) { 17749 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 17750 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 17751 QualType EltTy; 17752 17753 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 17754 Val = nullptr; 17755 17756 if (Val) 17757 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 17758 17759 if (Val) { 17760 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent()) 17761 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 17762 else { 17763 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 17764 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 17765 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 17766 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 17767 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 17768 // constant expression of the underlying type. 17769 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17770 ExprResult Converted = 17771 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 17772 CCEK_Enumerator); 17773 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 17774 Val = nullptr; 17775 else 17776 Val = Converted.get(); 17777 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 17778 !(Val = 17779 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 17780 .get())) { 17781 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 17782 } else { 17783 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 17784 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17785 17786 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 17787 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 17788 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 17789 // expression checking. 17790 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 17791 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 17792 .getTriple() 17793 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 17794 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 17795 } else { 17796 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 17797 } 17798 } 17799 17800 // Cast to the underlying type. 17801 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 17802 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 17803 : CK_IntegralCast) 17804 .get(); 17805 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17806 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 17807 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17808 // is the type of its initializing value: 17809 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 17810 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 17811 EltTy = Val->getType(); 17812 } else { 17813 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 17814 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 17815 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 17816 // representable as an int. 17817 17818 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 17819 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 17820 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 17821 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange() 17822 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 17823 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 17824 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 17825 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 17826 } 17827 EltTy = Val->getType(); 17828 } 17829 } 17830 } 17831 } 17832 17833 if (!Val) { 17834 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 17835 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 17836 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 17837 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 17838 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17839 // is the type of its initializing value: 17840 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 17841 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 17842 // 17843 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 17844 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 17845 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 17846 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17847 } 17848 else { 17849 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 17850 } 17851 } else { 17852 // Assign the last value + 1. 17853 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17854 ++EnumVal; 17855 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 17856 17857 // Check for overflow on increment. 17858 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 17859 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 17860 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17861 // is the type of its initializing value: 17862 // 17863 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 17864 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 17865 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 17866 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 17867 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 17868 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 17869 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 17870 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 17871 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 17872 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 17873 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17874 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 17875 ++EnumVal; 17876 if (Enum->isFixed()) 17877 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 17878 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 17879 << toString(EnumVal, 10) 17880 << EltTy; 17881 else 17882 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 17883 << toString(EnumVal, 10); 17884 } else { 17885 EltTy = T; 17886 } 17887 17888 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 17889 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 17890 // value, then increment. 17891 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17892 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 17893 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 17894 ++EnumVal; 17895 17896 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 17897 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 17898 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 17899 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 17900 // integral type. 17901 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 17902 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 17903 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17904 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 17905 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 17906 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 17907 << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1; 17908 } 17909 } 17910 } 17911 17912 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 17913 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 17914 // enumerator's type. 17915 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 17916 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 17917 } 17918 17919 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 17920 Val, EnumVal); 17921 } 17922 17923 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 17924 SourceLocation IILoc) { 17925 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 17926 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 17927 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17928 17929 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 17930 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 17931 // skip the body. 17932 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 17933 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 17934 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 17935 if (!PrevECD) 17936 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17937 17938 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 17939 NamedDecl *Hidden; 17940 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 17941 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 17942 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 17943 return Skip; 17944 } 17945 17946 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17947 } 17948 17949 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 17950 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 17951 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 17952 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 17953 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 17954 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 17955 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 17956 17957 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 17958 // we find one that is. 17959 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 17960 17961 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 17962 // scope. 17963 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17964 LookupName(R, S); 17965 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17966 17967 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17968 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17969 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 17970 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17971 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17972 } 17973 17974 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 17975 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 17976 // different from T: 17977 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 17978 // enumerated type 17979 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 17980 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 17981 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 17982 17983 EnumConstantDecl *New = 17984 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 17985 if (!New) 17986 return nullptr; 17987 17988 if (PrevDecl) { 17989 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17990 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 17991 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 17992 } 17993 17994 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 17995 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 17996 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 17997 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 17998 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 17999 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18000 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 18001 else 18002 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 18003 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 18004 return nullptr; 18005 } 18006 } 18007 18008 // Process attributes. 18009 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 18010 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 18011 18012 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 18013 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 18014 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 18015 18016 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 18017 18018 return New; 18019 } 18020 18021 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 18022 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 18023 // Element2 = Element1 18024 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 18025 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 18026 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 18027 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 18028 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 18029 if (!InitExpr) 18030 return true; 18031 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 18032 18033 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 18034 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 18035 return true; 18036 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 18037 if (!IL) 18038 return true; 18039 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 18040 return true; 18041 18042 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 18043 } 18044 18045 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 18046 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 18047 if (!DRE) 18048 return true; 18049 18050 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 18051 if (!EnumConstant) 18052 return true; 18053 18054 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 18055 Enum) 18056 return true; 18057 18058 return false; 18059 } 18060 18061 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 18062 // a previous element has already been set to. 18063 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 18064 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 18065 // Avoid anonymous enums 18066 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 18067 return; 18068 18069 // Only check for small enums. 18070 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 18071 return; 18072 18073 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 18074 return; 18075 18076 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 18077 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 18078 18079 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 18080 18081 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 18082 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 18083 18084 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 18085 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 18086 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 18087 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 18088 }; 18089 18090 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 18091 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 18092 18093 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 18094 // an initializer. 18095 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18096 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18097 18098 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 18099 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 18100 if (!ECD) { 18101 return; 18102 } 18103 18104 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 18105 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 18106 continue; 18107 18108 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 18109 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 18110 } 18111 18112 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 18113 return; 18114 18115 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 18116 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 18117 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 18118 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 18119 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 18120 continue; 18121 18122 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 18123 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 18124 continue; 18125 18126 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 18127 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 18128 // Ensure constants are different. 18129 if (D == ECD) 18130 continue; 18131 18132 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 18133 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 18134 Vec->push_back(D); 18135 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18136 18137 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 18138 Entry = Vec.get(); 18139 18140 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 18141 // diagnostics. 18142 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 18143 continue; 18144 } 18145 18146 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 18147 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 18148 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 18149 continue; 18150 18151 Vec->push_back(ECD); 18152 } 18153 18154 // Emit diagnostics. 18155 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 18156 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 18157 18158 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 18159 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 18160 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 18161 << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18162 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 18163 18164 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 18165 // the same value. 18166 for (auto *ECD : llvm::make_range(Vec->begin() + 1, Vec->end())) 18167 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 18168 << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10) 18169 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 18170 } 18171 } 18172 18173 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 18174 bool AllowMask) const { 18175 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 18176 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 18177 18178 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 18179 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 18180 18181 if (R.second) { 18182 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 18183 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 18184 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 18185 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 18186 FlagBits = FlagBits.zextOrSelf(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 18187 } 18188 } 18189 18190 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 18191 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 18192 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 18193 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 18194 // 18195 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 18196 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 18197 // likely a logic error. 18198 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 18199 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 18200 } 18201 18202 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 18203 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 18204 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 18205 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 18206 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 18207 18208 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 18209 18210 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 18211 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18212 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18213 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18214 if (!ECD) continue; 18215 18216 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18217 } 18218 18219 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 18220 return; 18221 } 18222 18223 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 18224 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 18225 // emit a warning. 18226 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 18227 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 18228 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 18229 18230 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 18231 // reverse the list. 18232 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 18233 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 18234 18235 // Keep track of whether all elements have type int. 18236 bool AllElementsInt = true; 18237 18238 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18239 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18240 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18241 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18242 18243 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18244 18245 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18246 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 18247 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 18248 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 18249 else 18250 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18251 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18252 18253 // Keep track of whether every enum element has type int (very common). 18254 if (AllElementsInt) 18255 AllElementsInt = ECD->getType() == Context.IntTy; 18256 } 18257 18258 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18259 QualType BestType; 18260 unsigned BestWidth; 18261 18262 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18263 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 18264 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 18265 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 18266 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 18267 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 18268 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 18269 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 18270 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 18271 QualType BestPromotionType; 18272 18273 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 18274 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 18275 // enum definitions. 18276 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 18277 Packed = true; 18278 18279 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 18280 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 18281 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18282 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18283 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 18284 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 18285 else 18286 BestPromotionType = BestType; 18287 18288 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 18289 } 18290 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 18291 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 18292 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 18293 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18294 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 18295 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 18296 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18297 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 18298 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 18299 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 18300 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18301 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 18302 BestType = Context.IntTy; 18303 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18304 } else { 18305 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 18306 18307 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 18308 BestType = Context.LongTy; 18309 } else { 18310 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18311 18312 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 18313 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 18314 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 18315 } 18316 } 18317 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 18318 } else { 18319 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 18320 // all of the enumerator values. 18321 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18322 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 18323 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 18324 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18325 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18326 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 18327 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 18328 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18329 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18330 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 18331 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 18332 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18333 BestPromotionType 18334 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18335 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 18336 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 18337 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 18338 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 18339 BestPromotionType 18340 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18341 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 18342 } else { 18343 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18344 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 18345 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 18346 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 18347 BestPromotionType 18348 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18349 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 18350 } 18351 } 18352 18353 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 18354 // the type of the enum if needed. 18355 for (auto *D : Elements) { 18356 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18357 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18358 18359 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 18360 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 18361 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 18362 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 18363 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 18364 18365 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 18366 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18367 18368 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 18369 // the enum decl type. 18370 QualType NewTy; 18371 unsigned NewWidth; 18372 bool NewSign; 18373 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18374 !Enum->isFixed() && 18375 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 18376 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 18377 NewWidth = IntWidth; 18378 NewSign = true; 18379 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 18380 // Already the right type! 18381 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18382 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18383 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18384 // enumeration. 18385 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18386 continue; 18387 } else { 18388 NewTy = BestType; 18389 NewWidth = BestWidth; 18390 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 18391 } 18392 18393 // Adjust the APSInt value. 18394 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 18395 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 18396 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 18397 18398 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 18399 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 18400 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 18401 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 18402 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 18403 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 18404 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18405 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18406 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18407 // enumeration. 18408 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18409 else 18410 ECD->setType(NewTy); 18411 } 18412 18413 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 18414 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 18415 18416 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 18417 18418 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 18419 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 18420 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18421 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18422 18423 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18424 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 18425 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 18426 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 18427 << ECD << Enum; 18428 } 18429 } 18430 18431 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 18432 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 18433 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 18434 } 18435 18436 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 18437 SourceLocation StartLoc, 18438 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 18439 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 18440 18441 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 18442 AsmString, StartLoc, 18443 EndLoc); 18444 CurContext->addDecl(New); 18445 return New; 18446 } 18447 18448 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18449 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18450 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18451 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18452 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18453 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 18454 LookupOrdinaryName); 18455 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 18456 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 18457 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 18458 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*LiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 18459 18460 // If a declaration that: 18461 // 1) declares a function or a variable 18462 // 2) has external linkage 18463 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 18464 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18465 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 18466 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 18467 else 18468 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 18469 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 18470 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 18471 } else 18472 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 18473 } 18474 18475 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18476 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18477 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 18478 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 18479 18480 if (PrevDecl) { 18481 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 18482 } else { 18483 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 18484 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo> 18485 (Name, WeakInfo((IdentifierInfo*)nullptr, NameLoc))); 18486 } 18487 } 18488 18489 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18490 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18491 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18492 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18493 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18494 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 18495 LookupOrdinaryName); 18496 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 18497 18498 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18499 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 18500 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18501 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 18502 } else { 18503 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 18504 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo>(AliasName, W)); 18505 } 18506 } 18507 18508 Decl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 18509 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 18510 } 18511 18512 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 18513 bool Final) { 18514 assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl"); 18515 18516 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 18517 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 18518 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 18519 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18520 18521 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 18522 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 18523 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 18524 18525 // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition. 18526 auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() { 18527 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 18528 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 18529 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 18530 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 18531 18532 return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage( 18533 getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)); 18534 }; 18535 18536 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 18537 // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions 18538 // we don't need due to their linkage. 18539 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 18540 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 18541 // DevTy may be changed later by 18542 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). 18543 // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status 18544 // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true. 18545 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 18546 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 18547 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 18548 // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target 18549 // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols. 18550 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy.hasValue()) 18551 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 18552 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18553 // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed, 18554 // we'll omit it. 18555 if (Final) 18556 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 18557 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) { 18558 // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host 18559 // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to 18560 // be ommitted. 18561 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 18562 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 18563 if (DevTy.hasValue()) 18564 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) 18565 return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 18566 } 18567 18568 if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA) 18569 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18570 18571 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 18572 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 18573 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 18574 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 18575 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 18576 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 18577 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 18578 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 18579 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 18580 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 18581 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 18582 18583 if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol()) 18584 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18585 } 18586 18587 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 18588 // known-emitted functions. 18589 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 18590 } 18591 18592 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 18593 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 18594 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 18595 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 18596 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 18597 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 18598 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 18599 // known-emitted. 18600 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 18601 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 18602 } 18603